blob: 3ab2d48892d0fafbaeec3090bdd487773c3fab39 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a38ffc2020-11-21 16:00:40 +01007 2020/11/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
1084 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
1282 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1284
1285 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1286 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1287
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001288 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1289 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1290 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1291 designed to be used with a local log server.
1292
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001293 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1294 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1295 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1296 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1297 logger consumes.
1298
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001299 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1301 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1302 used with a local log server.
1303
1304 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1305 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1306 designed to be used with a local log server.
1307
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001308 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1309 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1310 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1311 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1312
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001313 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1314 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1315 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1316 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1317 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1318
1319 <sample_size>
1320 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1321 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1322 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1323 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1324 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1325
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001326 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001328 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1329 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1330 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1331
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1333 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1334 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1335 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
1337 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001338 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1339 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1340 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1341 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1342 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1343 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001346
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001347log-send-hostname [<string>]
1348 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1349 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1350 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1351 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1352 the logs.
1353
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001354log-tag <string>
1355 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1356 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1357 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001358 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001360lua-load <file>
1361 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1362 used multiple times.
1363
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001364lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1365 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1366 variable.
1367 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1368 to "path".
1369
1370 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1371 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1372 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1373 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1374 will be checked earlier.
1375
1376 As an example by specifying the following path:
1377
1378 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1379 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1380
1381 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1382 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1383 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1384 paths if that does not exist either.
1385
1386 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1387 documentation.
1388
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001389master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001390 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1391 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1392 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001393 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001394 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1395 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001396 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1397 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1398 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1399 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1400 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001401
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001402 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001403
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001404mworker-max-reloads <number>
1405 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001406 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001407 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1408 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1409 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1410
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001411nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1413 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1414 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001415 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1416 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001417 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1418 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1419 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001420
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001421nbthread <number>
1422 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001423 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1424 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1425 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1426 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1427 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001428 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1429 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1430 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1431 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1432 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1433 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1434 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001435
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001437 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1438 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1439 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1440 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001442pp2-never-send-local
1443 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1444 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1445 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1446 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1447 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1448 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1449 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1450 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1451 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1452 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1453 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1454
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001455presetenv <name> <value>
1456 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1457 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1458 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1459 and "unsetenv".
1460
1461resetenv [<name> ...]
1462 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1463 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1464 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1465 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1466 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1467 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1468 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1470
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001471stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001472 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1473 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1474 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1475 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1476 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1477 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001478 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001479 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1480 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1481 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1482 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001483
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001484server-state-base <directory>
1485 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001486 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1487 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001488
1489server-state-file <file>
1490 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1491 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1492 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1493 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1494 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1495 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1496 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1497 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001498 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1499 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001500
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001501setenv <name> <value>
1502 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1503 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1504 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1505 and "unsetenv".
1506
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001507set-dumpable
1508 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001509 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1510 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1511 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1512 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1513 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1514 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1515 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1516 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1517 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1518 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1519 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1520 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1521 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1522 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1523 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1524 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1525 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001526
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001527ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1529 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001530 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001531 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001532 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1533 information and recommendations see e.g.
1534 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1535 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1536 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1537 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001538
1539ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1541 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1542 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1543 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1544 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001545 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1546 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1547 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001548 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001549
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001550ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1552 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1553 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1554 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1555 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1556
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001557ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1559 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1560 keyword to see available options.
1561
1562 Example:
1563 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001564 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001565
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001566ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1568 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001569 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001570 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001571 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1572 information and recommendations see e.g.
1573 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1574 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1575 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1576 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1577 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001578
1579ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1581 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1582 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1583 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1584 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1586 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1587 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1588 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001589
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001590ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1592 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1593 keyword to see available options.
1594
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001595ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1598 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001601 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1602 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1603 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1604 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1606 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1607 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1608
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001609ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1610 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1611 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001612 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001613 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001614 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1615
1616 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001617
1618 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1619 and won't try to remove them.
1620
1621 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1622
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001623ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001624 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001625 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1626 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001627
1628 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1629 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1630 optimize the startup time.
1631
1632 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1633 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1634 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1635
1636 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001637 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001638
1639 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001640 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1641
1642 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1643 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1644 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1645 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1646 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1647 bind configuration..
1648
1649 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1650 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1651 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1652 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1653 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1654 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1655 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1656 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1657
1658 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1659
1660 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1661 a cert bundle.
1662
1663 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1664 separately in several "crt".
1665
1666 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1667 since files are loading separately.
1668
1669 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1670 required to commit them.
1671
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001672 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001673 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001674
1675 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1676
1677 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1678
1679 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1680 not provided in the PEM file.
1681
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001682 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1683 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1684
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001685 The default behavior is "all".
1686
1687 Example:
1688 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1689 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1690 ssl-load-extra-files none
1691
1692 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1693
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001694ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1695 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1696 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1697 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1698
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001699ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001700 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001701 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1702 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1703 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1704 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1705 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1706 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001707 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001708
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001709stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1710 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1711 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1712 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001713 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001714 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001715
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001716 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1717 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1718 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001719
1720stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1721 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1722 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001723 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats maxconn <connections>
1726 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1727 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729uid <number>
1730 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1731 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1732 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1733 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1734
1735ulimit-n <number>
1736 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1737 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1738 option.
1739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001740unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1741 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1742
1743 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1744 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1745 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1746 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1747 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1748 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1749 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1750 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1751 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1752 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1753
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001754unsetenv [<name> ...]
1755 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1756 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1757 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1758 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1759 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1760 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1761 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763user <user name>
1764 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1765 See also "uid" and "group".
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001767node <name>
1768 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1769
1770 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1771 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1772 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1773 traffic.
1774
1775description <text>
1776 Add a text that describes the instance.
1777
1778 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1779 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1780 "<" and ">" characters.
1781
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178251degrees-data-file <file path>
1783 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001785
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001786 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001787 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1788
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000178951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1791 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1792 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1793
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001794 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1796
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200179751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001798 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1799 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1800
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001801 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1802 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1803
180451degrees-cache-size <number>
1805 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1806 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1807 By default, this cache is disabled.
1808
1809 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001810 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1811
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001812wurfl-data-file <file path>
1813 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1814 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1815
1816 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1817 with USE_WURFL=1.
1818
1819wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1820 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1821 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1822 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1823
1824 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1825
1826 Valid WURFL properties are:
1827 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1828
1829 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1830 device.
1831
1832 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1833 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1834
1835 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1836 particular web request.
1837
1838 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1839 used Libwurfl API version.
1840
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001841 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1842 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1843
1844 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1845 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1846
1847 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1848
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001849 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1850 with USE_WURFL=1.
1851
1852wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1853 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1854 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1855
1856 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1857 with USE_WURFL=1.
1858
1859wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1860 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1861 thus before the chroot.
1862
1863 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1864 with USE_WURFL=1.
1865
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001866wurfl-cache-size <size>
1867 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1868 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001870 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001871
1872 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1873 with USE_WURFL=1.
1874
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001875strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001876 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1877 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1878 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1879 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1880 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883-----------------------
1884
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001885busy-polling
1886 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1887 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1888 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1889 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1890 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1891 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1892 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1893 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1894 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1895 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1896 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1897 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1898 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1899 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1900 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1901 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1902 "poll" pollers.
1903
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001904 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1905 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1906 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1907
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001908max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1909 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1910 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1911 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1912 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1913 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1914 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1915 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1916 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918maxconn <number>
1919 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1920 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1921 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001922 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1923 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1924 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1925 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001926 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1927 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1928 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1929 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1930 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1931 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001933maxconnrate <number>
1934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1941 fairness.
1942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001943maxcomprate <number>
1944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001950 default value.
1951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001952maxcompcpuusage <number>
1953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001962maxpipes <number>
1963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001970maxsessrate <number>
1971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1978 fairness.
1979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001980maxsslconn <number>
1981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001996maxsslrate <number>
1997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002008maxzlibmem <number>
2009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016noepoll
2017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020
2021nokqueue
2022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2025
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002026noevports
2027 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2028 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2029 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2030 also "nopoll".
2031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032nopoll
2033 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2034 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002036 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2037 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002038
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002039nosplice
2040 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002042 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002043 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2045 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2046 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2047 "option splice-response".
2048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002049nogetaddrinfo
2050 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2051 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2052
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002053noreuseport
2054 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2055 command line argument "-dR".
2056
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002057profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2058 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2059 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2060 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2061 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002062 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002063 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2064 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2065 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2066 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2067
2068 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2069 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2070 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2071 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2072 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002073 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2074 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2075 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2076 CLI.
2077
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002078spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002079 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2080 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2081 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2082 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2083 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2084 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002087 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002089 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2090 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2091 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2092 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2093 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002094 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2095 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002096 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2097 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2098 openssl configuration file uses:
2099 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2100
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002101ssl-mode-async
2102 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002103 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002104 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2105 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2106 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002107 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002108 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002109
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002110tune.buffers.limit <number>
2111 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2112 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2113 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2114 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2115 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002117 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2118 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2119 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2120 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2121 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2122 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2123 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2124 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2125 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2126
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002127tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2128 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2129 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2130 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2131 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2132
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002133tune.bufsize <number>
2134 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2135 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2136 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2137 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2138 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2139 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2140 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002141 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2142 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2143 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002144 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002145 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2146 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2147 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002148
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002149tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2150 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002151
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002152tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2153 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2154 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2155 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2156 this value. The default value is 1.
2157
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002158tune.fail-alloc
2159 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2160 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2161 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2162 gracefully.
2163
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002164tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2165 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2166 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2167 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2168 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2169 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2170
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002171tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2172 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2173 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2174 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2175 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2176 change it.
2177
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002178tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2179 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2181 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002182 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2183 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2184 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2185 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2186 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2187
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002188tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2189 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2190 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2191 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2192 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2193 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2194 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2195 recommended not to change this value.
2196
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002197tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2198 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2199 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2200 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2201 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2202 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2203 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2204 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2205
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002206tune.http.cookielen <number>
2207 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2208 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2209 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2210 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2211 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2212 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2213 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2214 to change this value.
2215
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002216tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002217 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2218 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002219 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002220 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221 configuration directives too.
2222 The default value is 1024.
2223
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002224tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2225 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2226 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2227 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2228 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2229 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2230 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002231 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2232 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2233 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002234
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002235tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2236 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2237 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2238 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2239 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2240 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2241 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2242 this option to "off". The default is on.
2243
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002244tune.idletimer <timeout>
2245 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2246 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2247 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2248 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2249 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2250 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002251 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002252 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002253 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2254
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002255tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2256 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2257 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2258 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2259 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2260 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2261 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2262 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2263 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2264 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2265
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002266tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2267 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002268 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002269 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2270 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002271 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002272 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2273 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2274
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002275tune.lua.maxmem
2276 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2277 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2278 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2279 memory.
2280
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002281tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2282 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002283 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2284 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002285 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286
2287tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2288 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2289 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2290 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2291 check servers.
2292
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002293tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2294 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2295 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2296 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002297 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002299tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002300 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2301 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2302 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2303 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2304 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2305 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2306 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2307 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2308 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2309 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002310
2311tune.maxpollevents <number>
2312 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2313 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2314 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2315 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2316 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2317
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002318tune.maxrewrite <number>
2319 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2320 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2321 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2322 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2323 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2324 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2325 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2326 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2327 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2328 bufsize.
2329
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002330tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2331 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2332 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2333 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2334 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2335 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2336 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2337 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2338 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2339 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002340 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2341 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002342 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2343 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2344 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2345 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2346 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2347 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2348 setting this parameter to 0.
2349
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002350tune.pipesize <number>
2351 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2352 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2353 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2354 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2355 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2356 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2357
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002358tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2359 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2360 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2361 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2362 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2363 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2364 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002365 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002366
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002367tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2368 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2369 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2370 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2371 default is 20.
2372
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002373tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2374tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2375 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2376 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2377 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002379 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002380 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2381 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2382
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002383tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002385 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2386 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2387 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2388 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2389
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002390tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002392 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002393 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2394 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2395 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2396
2397tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2399 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2400 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2401 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2402 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2403 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2404 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2405 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2406 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002407
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002408tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2409tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2410 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2411 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2412 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002413 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002414 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002415 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2416 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2417 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2418 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2419 notifying haproxy again.
2420
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002421tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002422 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2423 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2424 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002425 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002426 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002427 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002428 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2429 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2430 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002431 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2432 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002433
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002434tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002435 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002436 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2437 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2438 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2439 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2440 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2441
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002442tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2443 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2444 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2445 performances. This is disabled by default.
2446
2447 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2448 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2449
2450 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2451
2452 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2453
2454 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2455
2456 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2457 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2458 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2459
2460 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2461 converted.
2462
2463 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2464 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2465 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2466 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2467 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2468 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2469 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002470 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2471 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002472
2473 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2474
2475 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2476 only need this line:
2477
2478 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2479
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002480tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2481 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002482 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002483 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2484 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2485 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2486 being used for too long.
2487
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002488tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2489 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2490 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2491 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2492 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2493 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2494 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2495 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2496 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2497 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2498 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002499 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002500 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002501
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002502tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2503 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2504 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2505 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2506 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002507 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002508 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2509 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002510 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2511 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002512
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002513tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2514 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2515 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2516 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2517 1000 entries.
2518
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002519tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2520 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2521 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2522 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2523
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002524tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002525tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002526tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2527tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2528tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002529 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2530 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2531 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2532 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2533 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2534 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2535 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2536 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002537
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002538 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2539 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2540 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2541 all available space is consumed.
2542 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2543 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2544 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002545
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002546tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2547 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002548 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002549 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002550 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002551 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2552
2553tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2554 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2555 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2557 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025593.3. Debugging
2560--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002561
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002562quiet
2563 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2564 line argument "-q".
2565
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002566zero-warning
2567 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2568 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2569 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2570 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2571 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2572 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2573
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025753.4. Userlists
2576--------------
2577It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2578http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2579it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2580
2581userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002582 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002583 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2584
2585group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002586 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002587 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2588 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002590user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2591 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2593 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002594 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2595 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2596 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2597 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002598
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002599 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2600 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2601 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2602 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2603 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2604 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2605 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2606 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2607 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002608
2609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610 userlist L1
2611 group G1 users tiger,scott
2612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2615 user scott insecure-password elgato
2616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618 userlist L2
2619 group G1
2620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002625
2626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002628
26293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002643
2644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2647
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002648bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2649 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2650 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2651
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002652disabled
2653 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2654 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2655 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2656
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002657default-bind [param*]
2658 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2659
2660default-server [param*]
2661 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2662
2663 Arguments:
2664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2667 details.
2668
2669
2670 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2671
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002672enable
2673 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2674
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002675log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2676 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2677 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2678 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2679 more details.
2680
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002681peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002682 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2683 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002684 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2685 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2686 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2687 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2688 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002689
2690 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2691 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2692
2693 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002694 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2695 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2696 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002697
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002698 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2699 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002700
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002701 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2702 "server" keyword explanation below).
2703
2704server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002705 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002706 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2707 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2708 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2709 of this "peers" section).
2710 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2711
2712
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002713 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002714 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002715 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002716 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2717 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2718 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719
2720 backend mybackend
2721 mode tcp
2722 balance roundrobin
2723 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2724 stick on src
2725
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002726 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2727 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002729 Example:
2730 peers mypeers
2731 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2732 default-server ssl verify none
2733 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2734 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002735
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002736
2737table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2738 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2739
2740 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2741 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002743 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2744 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2745 "stick-table" keyword).
2746
2747 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2748 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2749 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2750 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2751 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2752 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2753 of the stick-table name as follows:
2754
2755 peers mypeers
2756 peer A ...
2757 peer B ...
2758 table t1 ...
2759
2760 frontend fe1
2761 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2762
2763 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2764 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2765
2766 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2767 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2768 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2769 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2770 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2771 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2772 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2773
2774 peers mypeers
2775 peer A ...
2776 peer B ...
2777 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2778
2779 backend t1
2780 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2781
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002782 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002783 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2784 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027863.6. Mailers
2787------------
2788It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2789If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2790in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2791
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002792mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002793 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2794 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2795
2796mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2797 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2798
2799 Example:
2800 mailers mymailers
2801 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2802 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2803
2804 backend mybackend
2805 mode tcp
2806 balance roundrobin
2807
2808 email-alert mailers mymailers
2809 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2810 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2811
2812 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2813 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2814
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002815timeout mail <time>
2816 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2817 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2818 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2819 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2820
2821 Example:
2822 mailers mymailers
2823 timeout mail 20s
2824 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002825
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028263.7. Programs
2827-------------
2828In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2829master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2830managed the same way as the workers.
2831
2832During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2833sequence as a worker:
2834
2835 - the master is re-executed
2836 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2837 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2838 instance of the program
2839
2840During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2841
2842program <name>
2843 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2844 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2845 the management guide).
2846
2847command <command> [arguments*]
2848 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2849 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2850 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2851 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2852
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002853user <user name>
2854 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2855 See also "group".
2856
2857group <group name>
2858 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2859 See also "user".
2860
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002861option start-on-reload
2862no option start-on-reload
2863 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2864 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2865 program section.
2866
2867
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028683.8. HTTP-errors
2869----------------
2870
2871It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2872imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2873several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2874
2875http-errors <name>
2876 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2877 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2878
2879errorfile <code> <file>
2880 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2881
2882 Arguments :
2883 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002884 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2885 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002886
2887 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2888 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2889 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2890 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2891 before any chroot is performed.
2892
2893 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2894
2895 Example:
2896 http-errors website-1
2897 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2898 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2899 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2900
2901 http-errors website-2
2902 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2903 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2904 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2905
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029063.9. Rings
2907----------
2908
2909It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2910servers or traces.
2911
2912ring <ringname>
2913 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2914
2915description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002916 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002917 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2918
2919format <format>
2920 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2921
2922 Arguments:
2923 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2924 one of the following :
2925
2926 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2927 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2928 designed to be used with a local log server.
2929
2930 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2931 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2932 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2933 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2934 is the default.
2935
2936 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2937 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2938
2939 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2940 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2941
2942 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2943 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2944 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2945 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2946 logger consumes.
2947
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002948 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2949 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2950 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2951 with a local log server.
2952
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002953 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2954 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2955 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2956 used with a local log server.
2957
2958maxlen <length>
2959 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2960 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2961 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2962
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002963server <name> <address> [param*]
2964 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2965 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2966 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2967 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2968 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2969 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2970 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2971 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2972 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002973 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2974 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002975
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002976size <size>
2977 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2978 set to BUFSIZE.
2979
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002980timeout connect <timeout>
2981 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2982
2983 Arguments :
2984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2986 as explained at the top of this document.
2987
2988timeout server <timeout>
2989 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2990
2991 Arguments :
2992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2994 as explained at the top of this document.
2995
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002996 Example:
2997 global
2998 log ring@myring local7
2999
3000 ring myring
3001 description "My local buffer"
3002 format rfc3164
3003 maxlen 1200
3004 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003005 timeout connect 5s
3006 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003007 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003008
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030093.10. Log forwarding
3010-------------------
3011
3012It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3013haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3014
3015log-forward <name>
3016 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3017
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003018backlog <conns>
3019 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3020 on connections accept.
3021
3022bind <addr> [param*]
3023 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003024 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3025 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3026 syslog protocol over TCP.
3027 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003028 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3029
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003030dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003031 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3032 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3033 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3034 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003035 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003036
3037log global
3038log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3039 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3040 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3041 documentation.
3042 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3043 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3044 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3045 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3046 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3047
3048 Example:
3049 global
3050 log stderr format iso local7
3051
3052 ring myring
3053 description "My local buffer"
3054 format rfc5424
3055 maxlen 1200
3056 size 32764
3057 timeout connect 5s
3058 timeout server 10s
3059 # syslog tcp server
3060 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3061
3062 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003063 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3064 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003065 # all messages on stderr
3066 log global
3067 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3068 log ring@myring local0
3069 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3070 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3071 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3072 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3073 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003074
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003075maxconn <conns>
3076 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3077 10 is the default.
3078
3079timeout client <timeout>
3080 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030824. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003083----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003085Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003086 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003087 - frontend <name>
3088 - backend <name>
3089 - listen <name>
3090
3091A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3092its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3093section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003095
3096A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3097connections.
3098
3099A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3100to forward incoming connections.
3101
3102A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3103parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3106'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3107case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3108
3109Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3110logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3111proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3112However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3113name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3114
3115Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3116and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003117bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3119modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3120arbitrary criteria.
3121
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003122In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3123a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003124the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003125
3126 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3127 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3128 between responses and new requests.
3129
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003130 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3131 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3132 client-facing connection remains open.
3133
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003134 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3135 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003136
3137The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3138frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3139following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003140weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003141
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003142 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3145 ----+-----+-----+----
3146 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3147 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003148 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3149 ----+-----+-----+----
3150 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031544.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3155--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003157The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3158limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3159they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3160limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003161marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003163and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3164with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3165specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003167
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003168 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3169------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3170acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003171backlog X X X -
3172balance X - X X
3173bind - X X -
3174bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003175capture cookie - X X -
3176capture request header - X X -
3177capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003178clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3179clitcpka-idle X X X -
3180clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003181compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003182cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003183declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003184default-server X - X X
3185default_backend X X X -
3186description - X X X
3187disabled X X X X
3188dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003189email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003190email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003191email-alert mailers X X X X
3192email-alert myhostname X X X X
3193email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194enabled X X X X
3195errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003196errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003197errorloc X X X X
3198errorloc302 X X X X
3199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3200errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003201force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003202filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003203fullconn X - X X
3204grace X X X X
3205hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003206http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003207http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003208http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003209http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003210http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003211http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003212http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003213http-check set-var X - X X
3214http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003215http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003216http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003217http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003218http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003219http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003221ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003222load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003223log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003224log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003225log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003226log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003227max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003228maxconn X X X -
3229mode X X X X
3230monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003231monitor-uri X X X -
3232option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3233option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3234option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3235option allbackups (*) X - X X
3236option checkcache (*) X - X X
3237option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3238option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003239option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003240option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3241option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3243option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003244option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3245option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003246option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003247option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003248option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003249option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003250option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003251option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3252option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3253option httpchk X - X X
3254option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003255option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003256option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003258option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003259option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003260option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3261option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3262option logasap (*) X X X -
3263option mysql-check X - X X
3264option nolinger (*) X X X X
3265option originalto X X X X
3266option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003267option pgsql-check X - X X
3268option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003269option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003270option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003271option smtpchk X - X X
3272option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3273option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3274option splice-request (*) X X X X
3275option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003276option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003277option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3278option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3279-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003280option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3282option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3283option tcpka X X X X
3284option tcplog X X X X
3285option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003286external-check command X - X X
3287external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003288persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3289rate-limit sessions X X X -
3290redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003293retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003294server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003295server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003296server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003297source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003298srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3299srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3300srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003301stats admin - X X X
3302stats auth X X X X
3303stats enable X X X X
3304stats hide-version X X X X
3305stats http-request - X X X
3306stats realm X X X X
3307stats refresh X X X X
3308stats scope X X X X
3309stats show-desc X X X X
3310stats show-legends X X X X
3311stats show-node X X X X
3312stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003313-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3314stick match - - X X
3315stick on - - X X
3316stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003317stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003318stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003319tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003320tcp-check connect X - X X
3321tcp-check expect X - X X
3322tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003323tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003324tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003325tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003326tcp-check set-var X - X X
3327tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003328tcp-request connection - X X -
3329tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003330tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003331tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003332tcp-response content - - X X
3333tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003334timeout check X - X X
3335timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003336timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003337timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003338timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3339timeout http-request X X X X
3340timeout queue X - X X
3341timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003342timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003343timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003344timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003345transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003346unique-id-format X X X -
3347unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003349use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003350use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3352 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033554.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3356---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
3358This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3359
3360
3361acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3362 Declare or complete an access list.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | yes
3365 Example:
3366 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3367 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3368 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003370 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
3372
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003373backlog <conns>
3374 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | no
3377 Arguments :
3378 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3379 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003380 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003381
3382 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3383 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3384 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3385 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3386 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3387 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3388 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3389 backlog parameter.
3390
3391 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3392 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3393 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3394
3395 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3396
3397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003399balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003400 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | no | yes | yes
3403 Arguments :
3404 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3405 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3406 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3407 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3408
3409 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3410 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3411 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3412 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003413 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003414 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003415 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3416 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3417 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3418 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3419 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3420 it, so that you don't worry.
3421
3422 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3423 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3424 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3425 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3426 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3427 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3428 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3429 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003431 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3432 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3433 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3434 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3435 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3436 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3437 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003438 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3439 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3440 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003441
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003442 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003443 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003444 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3445 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003446 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003447 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3448 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3449 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3450 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3451 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003452 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3453 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3454 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3455 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3456 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3457 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3460 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3461 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3462 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3463 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3464 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3465 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3466 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003467 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003469 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3470 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3471 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003473 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3474 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3475 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3476 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3477 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3478 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3479 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3480 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3481 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3482 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3483 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3484 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003486 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003487 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3488 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3489 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3490 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3491 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3492 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3493 URIs start with a leading "/".
3494
3495 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3496 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3497 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3498 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3499
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003500 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3501 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3502 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3503 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003506 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3507
3508 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003509 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3510 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003511 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3512 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3513 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3514 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003515 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003516 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3517 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003518
3519 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3520 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3521 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3522 server will receive the request.
3523
3524 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3525 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3526 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3527 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3528 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003529 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3530 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3531 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003533 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3534 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3535 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3536 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3537 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003539 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003540 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3541 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3542 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3543
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003544 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3545 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3546 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3547
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003548 random
3549 random(<draws>)
3550 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003551 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3552 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3553 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3554 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003555 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3556 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3557 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3558 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3559 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3560 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3561 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3562 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3563 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3564 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3565 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3566 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3567 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3568 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3569 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3570 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3571 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3572 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3573 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3574 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003575
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003576 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003577 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003578 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3579 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3580 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3581 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3582 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3583 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003584 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003585 used instead.
3586
3587 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3588 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3589 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3590 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3591
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003592 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3593 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3594 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003596 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003599 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3600 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003601
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003602 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3603 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3604 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003606 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003607 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003608 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3609 NTLM relies on.
3610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 Examples :
3612 balance roundrobin
3613 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003614 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003615 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3616 balance hdr(host)
3617 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003618
3619 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3620 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003622 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003623 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3624 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3625 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003626 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003627
3628 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3629 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3630 defaults to 16 kB.
3631
3632 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3633 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3634
3635 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3636 Round Robin.
3637
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003638 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003639 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3640 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3641 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3642
3643 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3644
3645 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003646 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003647 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3648 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3649 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003651 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003654bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3655bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 no | yes | yes | no
3659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003660 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3661 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3662 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3663 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003664 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003665 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3666 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3667 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3668 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3669 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3670 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003671 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003672 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3673 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003674 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003675 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3676 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003677 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003678 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3679 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003680 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003681 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3682 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3683 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3684 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3685 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3686 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3687 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003688 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3689 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3690 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003691 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3692 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3693 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3694 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3696 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3697 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003698
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003699 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3700 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003701 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3702 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3703 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003704 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3705 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3706 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3707 the range.
3708
3709 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3710 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3711 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3712 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3713 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3714 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3715 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003716 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003717 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003718
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003719 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003720 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003721 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3722 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3723 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3724 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3725 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3726 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003728 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3729 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3730 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3731 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3734 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3735 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3736 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3737 in a frontend.
3738
3739 Example :
3740 listen http_proxy
3741 bind :80,:443
3742 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003743 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003745 listen http_https_proxy
3746 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003747 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003748
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003749 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3750 bind ipv6@:80
3751 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3752 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3753
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003754 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003756
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003757 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3758 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3759 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3760 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3761 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3762
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003763 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003764 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003765
3766
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003767bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003768 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
3772 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3773 may be used to override a default value.
3774
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003775 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003776 option may be combined with other numbers.
3777
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003778 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003779 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3780 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3781 missing from all processes.
3782
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003783 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003784 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003785 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3786 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3787 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3788 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3789 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003790 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003791
3792 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3793 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3794 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3795 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3796 and 'even' instances.
3797
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003798 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3799 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3800 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3801 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003802
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003803 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3804 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3805
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003806 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3807 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3808 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3809
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003810 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3811 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3812
3813 Example :
3814 listen app_ip1
3815 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003816 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003817
3818 listen app_ip2
3819 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003820 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821
3822 listen management
3823 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003824 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003825
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003826 listen management
3827 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3828 bind-process 1-4
3829
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003830 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833capture cookie <name> len <length>
3834 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 no | yes | yes | no
3837 Arguments :
3838 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3839 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3840 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3841 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003842 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843
3844 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3845 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3846 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3847 right if it exceeds <length>.
3848
3849 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3850 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3851 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3852 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3853
3854 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3855 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3856 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3857
3858 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3859 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3860 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003861 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3862 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3863 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864
3865 Example:
3866 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3867
3868 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003869 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
3871
3872capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003873 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 no | yes | yes | no
3876 Arguments :
3877 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003878 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003879 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3880 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3881 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3882
3883 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3884 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3885 it exceeds <length>.
3886
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003887 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3889 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003890 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3891 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3892 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3893 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003894 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003895 environments to find where the request came from.
3896
3897 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3898 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3899 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3900 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003902 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3903 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3904 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3905 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3906 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907
3908 Example:
3909 capture request header Host len 15
3910 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003911 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003913 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 about logging.
3915
3916
3917capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003918 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 no | yes | yes | no
3921 Arguments :
3922 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003923 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3925 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3926 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3927
3928 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3929 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3930 it exceeds <length>.
3931
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003932 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3934 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3935 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003936 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3937 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3938 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3939 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003941 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3942 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3943 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3944 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3945 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
3947 Example:
3948 capture response header Content-length len 9
3949 capture response header Location len 15
3950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003951 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 about logging.
3953
3954
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003955clitcpka-cnt <count>
3956 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3957 the connection on the client side.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments :
3961 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3962
3963 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3964 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003965 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3966 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003967
3968 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3969
3970
3971clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3972 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3973 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3974 client side.
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | no
3977 Arguments :
3978 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3979 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3980 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3981 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3982
3983 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3984 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003985 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3986 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003987
3988 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3989
3990
3991clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3992 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | no
3995 Arguments :
3996 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3997 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3998 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3999 document.
4000
4001 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4002 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004003 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4004 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004005
4006 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4007
4008
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004009compression algo <algorithm> ...
4010compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004011compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004012 Enable HTTP compression.
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | yes | yes | yes
4015 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004016 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4017 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4018 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4019
4020 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004021 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4022 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4023 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004024
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004025 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004026 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004027
4028 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4029 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4030 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4031 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4032 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004033 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004034
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4036 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4037 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4038 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4039 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4040 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4041 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004042 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004043
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004044 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004045 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004046 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4047 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4048 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4049 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4050 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004051
4052 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4053 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4054 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4055 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4056 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004057 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4058 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4059 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4060 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4061 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004062 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4063 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004064
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004065 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004066 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4067 "Accept-Encoding" header
4068 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004069 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004070 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4071 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4072 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4073 "multipart"
4074 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4075 header
4076 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4077 and later
4078 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4079 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004080 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004081
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004082 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004083
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004084 Examples :
4085 compression algo gzip
4086 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004088
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004089cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004090 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4091 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004092 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
4097 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4098 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4099 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4100 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4101 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4102 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004103 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4105 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4106
4107 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4108 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4109 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4110 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4111 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4112 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004113 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4114 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004116 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4117 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118
4119 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004120 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004121
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004122 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004123 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004124 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004126 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4127 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4128 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4129 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4130 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4131 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4132 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
4134 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4135 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4136 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4137 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4138 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4139 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4140 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4141 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4142 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004143 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004144 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4145 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4146 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004148 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4149 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4150 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004151 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4152 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4153 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4154 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004155 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4156 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4157 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158
4159 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4160 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4161 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4162 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4163 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4164 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4165 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4166 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4167 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4168
4169 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4170 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4171 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4172 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4173 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4174 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4175 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4176 persistence cookie in the cache.
4177 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4178
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004179 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4180 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4181 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4182 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4183 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004185 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4186 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4187 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4188 they logout.
4189
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004190 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4191 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4192 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4193 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4194
4195 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4196 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4197 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4198 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4199 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4200 this attribute.
4201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004202 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004203 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004204 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4205 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4206 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4207 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4208 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4209 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004210
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004211 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4212 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4213 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4214 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4215 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4216 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4217 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4218 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004219 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004220 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4221 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4222 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4223 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4224 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4225 the site.
4226
4227 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4228 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4229 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4230 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4231 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4232 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4233 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4234 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4235 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4236 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4237 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4238 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4239 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004240 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004241 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4242 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4243
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004244 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4245 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4246 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4247 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4248 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4249 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4250
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004251 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4252 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4253 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4254 repeated.
4255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4257 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4258 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4259 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261 Examples :
4262 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4263 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4264 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004265 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004267 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004269
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004270declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4271 Declares a capture slot.
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 no | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments:
4275 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4276
4277 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4278 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4279 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4280 for use in the response.
4281
4282 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004283 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004284 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4285
4286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004287default-server [param*]
4288 Change default options for a server in a backend
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | no | yes | yes
4291 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4295 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004296
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004297 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004298 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4299
4300 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303default_backend <backend>
4304 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 yes | yes | yes | no
4307 Arguments :
4308 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4309
4310 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4311 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4312 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4313 will catch all undetermined requests.
4314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315 Example :
4316
4317 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4318 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4319 default_backend dynamic
4320
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004321 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004324description <string>
4325 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 no | yes | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : string
4329
4330 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4331 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4332 it describes.
4333 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4334
4335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336disabled
4337 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | yes
4340 Arguments : none
4341
4342 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4343 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4344 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4345 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4346 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4347 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4348 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4349
4350 See also : "enabled"
4351
4352
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004353dispatch <address>:<port>
4354 Set a default server address
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004357 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004358
4359 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4360 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4361 during start-up.
4362
4363 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4364 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4365 possible with normal servers.
4366
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004367 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004368 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4369 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4370 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4371 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4372
4373 See also : "server"
4374
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004375
4376dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4377 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
4380 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4381
4382 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004383 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004384 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4385 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004387 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389enabled
4390 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | yes | yes | yes
4393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4396 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4397
4398 See also : "disabled"
4399
4400
4401errorfile <code> <file>
4402 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004407 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004408 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409
4410 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004411 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004413 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4414 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004415
4416 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4417 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4418 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4419
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004420 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4421
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004422 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4423 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4424 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4425 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4426 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4427 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4428 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4429 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4430 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4433 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4434 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004435 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4437
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004438 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004439
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004440 Example :
4441 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004442 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004443 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4444 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004447errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4448 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4449 section.
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | yes | yes | yes
4452 Arguments :
4453 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4454
4455 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004456 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004457 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004458
4459 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4460 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4461 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4462 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4463 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004464 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004465 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4466
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004467 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4468 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004469
4470 Example :
4471 errorfiles generic
4472 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4473
4474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475errorloc <code> <url>
4476errorloc302 <code> <url>
4477 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | yes | yes | yes
4480 Arguments :
4481 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004482 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004483 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484
4485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490
4491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004501 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4503 request.
4504
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004505 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004506
4507
4508errorloc303 <code> <url>
4509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | yes | yes | yes
4512 Arguments :
4513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004514 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004515 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516
4517 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4518 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4519 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4520 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004521 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004522
4523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004529 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4530 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4531 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4532 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004533 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004535 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536
4537
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004538email-alert from <emailaddr>
4539 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004540 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 yes | yes | yes | yes
4543
4544 Arguments :
4545
4546 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4547
4548 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4549 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4550
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004551 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004552 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4553 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004554
4555
4556email-alert level <level>
4557 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4558 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 yes | yes | yes | yes
4561
4562 Arguments :
4563
4564 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4565 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4566 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4567
4568 By default level is alert
4569
4570 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4571 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4572 for the proxy.
4573
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004574 Alerts are sent when :
4575
4576 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4577 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4578 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4579 is notice or lower
4580 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4581 and a health check status update occurs
4582
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004583 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4584 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004585 section 3.6 about mailers.
4586
4587
4588email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4589 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | yes | yes | yes
4592
4593 Arguments :
4594
4595 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4596
4597 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4598 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4599
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004600 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4601 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004602
4603
4604email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4605 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4606 mailers.
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609
4610 Arguments :
4611
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004612 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004613
4614 By default the systems hostname is used.
4615
4616 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4617 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4618 for the proxy.
4619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004620 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4621 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004622
4623
4624email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004625 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004626 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | yes | yes | yes
4629
4630 Arguments :
4631
4632 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4633
4634 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4635 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4636
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004637 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004638 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004641force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4642 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004644 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004645
4646 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4647 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4648 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4649 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4650 marked down for maintenance operations.
4651
4652 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4653 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4654 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4655 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4656 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4657 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4658 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4659 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4660 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4661
4662 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4663 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4664 is used.
4665
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004666 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004667 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004668
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004669
4670filter <name> [param*]
4671 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4676 referenced in section 9.
4677
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004678 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004679 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004680 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4681 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004682
4683 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4684 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4685
4686 Example:
4687 listen
4688 bind *:80
4689
4690 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4691 filter compression
4692 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4693
4694 compression algo gzip
4695 compression offload
4696
4697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4698
4699 See also : section 9.
4700
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702fullconn <conns>
4703 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | no | yes | yes
4706 Arguments :
4707 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4708 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4709
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004710 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004711 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004712 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004713 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4714 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4715 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4716 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4717 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004718 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004720 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4721 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004722 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4723 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4724 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004726 Example :
4727 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4728 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4729 # connections.
4730 backend dynamic
4731 fullconn 10000
4732 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4733 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4734
4735 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4736
4737
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004738grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004742 Arguments :
4743 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4744 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4745 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4746
4747 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4748 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004749 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4751
4752 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4753 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4754 simplify it.
4755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004756
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004757hash-balance-factor <factor>
4758 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | no | no | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4763 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004764 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004765
4766 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4767 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4768 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4769 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4770 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4771 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4772 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4773
4774 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4775 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4776 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4777 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4778 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4779
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004780 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4781 consistent hashing mechanism.
4782
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004783 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4784
4785
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004786hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004787 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | no | yes | yes
4790 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004791 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4792 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004793
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004794 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4795 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4796 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4797 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4798 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4799 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4800 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4801 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4802 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4803 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004804
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004805 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4806 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4807 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4808 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4809 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4810 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4811 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4812 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4813 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4814 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4815 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4816 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4817 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004818 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4819 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004820
4821 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4822
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004823 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4825 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4826 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004827 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4828 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4829 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004830
4831 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4832 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004833 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4834 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4835 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4836 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4837
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004838 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4839 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4840 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4841 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4842 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4843 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4844 parameter.
4845
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004846 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4847 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4848 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4849 used on strings.
4850
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004851 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4852
4853 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4854 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4855 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4856 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4857 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4858 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4859 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4860 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4861 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4862 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4863 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4864 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004865
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004866 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4867 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4868 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004869
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004870 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004871
4872
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004873http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4874 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4875 ones).
4876
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | yes
4879
4880 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4881 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4882 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4883 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4884 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4885 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4886
4887 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4888 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4889 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4890
4891 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4892 below.
4893
4894 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4895 instance.
4896
4897 Example:
4898 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4899 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4900 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4901
4902http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4903
4904 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4905 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4906 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4907 example, or to pass some internal information.
4908 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4909 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4910 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4911
4912http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4915 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4916
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004917http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004918
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004919 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4920 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4921 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4922 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4923 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004924
4925http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4926 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4927
4928 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4929
4930 Example:
4931 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4932
4933 # applied to:
4934 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4935
4936 # outputs:
4937 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4938
4939 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4940
4941http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943
4944 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4945
4946 Example:
4947 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4948
4949 # applied to:
4950 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4951
4952 # outputs:
4953 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4954
4955http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4956
4957 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4958 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4959 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4960
4961http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4963
4964 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4965 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4966 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4967 fallback.
4968
4969 Example:
4970 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4971 http-response set-status 431
4972 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4973 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4974
4975http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976
4977 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4978 inline.
4979
4980 Arguments:
4981 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4982 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4983 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4984 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4985 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4986 (request and response)
4987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4988 processing
4989 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4990 processing
4991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4992 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4993 and '_'.
4994
4995 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4996 followed by some converters.
4997
4998 Example:
4999 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5000
5001http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5002
5003 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5004 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5005 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5006 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5007 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005008 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005009 processing.
5010
5011 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5012 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005013 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005014 rules evaluation.
5015
5016http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5017
5018 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5019 details about <var-name>.
5020
5021 Example:
5022 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5023
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005024
5025http-check comment <string>
5026 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5027 it fails.
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005031 Arguments :
5032 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5033 rule fails.
5034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005035 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5036 user-friendly error reporting.
5037
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005038 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005039 "http-check expect".
5040
5041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005042http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5043 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005044 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005045 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005049 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005050 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5051
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005052 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005053 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005054
5055 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5056 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5057 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5058 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5059
5060 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5061
5062 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5063
5064 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5065
5066 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5067
5068 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5069
5070 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5071 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5072 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5073 is used.
5074
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005075 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5076 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5077 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5078 haproxy -vv.
5079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005080 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005082 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5083 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5084 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5085 different ports or with different servers.
5086
5087 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5088 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5089 the port with a "http-check connect".
5090
5091 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5092 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5093 do.
5094
5095 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5096 unset-var or comment rules.
5097
5098 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005099 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5100 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5101 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5102 option httpchk
5103
5104 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005105 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005106 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005107 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005108 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005109 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005110
5111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5112
5113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005116http-check disable-on-404
5117 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005120 Arguments : none
5121
5122 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5123 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5124 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5125 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5126 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5127 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5128 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5129 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005130 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5131 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5132 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5133
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005134 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005135
5136
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005137http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005138 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5139 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5140 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005141 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005143 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005144
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005145 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005146 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5147
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5149 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5150 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5151 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5152 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5153 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5154 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5155 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5156 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5157 result is always conclusive.
5158
5159 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5160 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5161 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005162 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5163 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5164 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5165 example 404 with disable-on-404
5166 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5167 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5168 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005169
5170 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5171 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005172 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5173 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5174 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5175 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5176 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5177 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005178
5179 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5180 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005181 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5182 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5183 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5184 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005185 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5186
5187 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5188 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5189 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5190 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5191
5192 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5193 informational message reported in logs if an error
5194 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5195 log-format string.
5196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005197 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005198 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5199 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005200 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5201 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5202 details on the supported keywords.
5203
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005204 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5205 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5206 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5207 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005208
5209 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5210 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5211 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5212 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5213 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5214
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005215 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5216 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5217 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5218 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5219 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5220 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5221 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005222
5223 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005224 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005225 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5226 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5227 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5228 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5229
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005230 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5231 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005232 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5233 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5234 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5235 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5236 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5237 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5238 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5239 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005240 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5241 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5242 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5243 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5244 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5245 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5246 insensitive on the header names.
5247
5248 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5249 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5250 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5251 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5252 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5253 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005254
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005255 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005256 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005257 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5258 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5259 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5260 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5261 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005262 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005263 trace).
5264
5265 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005266 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005267 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5268 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5269 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5270 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5271 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005272 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005273
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005274 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5275 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5276 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5277 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5278 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5279 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5280
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005281 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005282 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005283 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5284 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5285 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5286 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5287 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5288 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5289
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005290 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5291 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5292 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5293 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5294 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005295
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005296 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5297 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5298
5299 Examples :
5300 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005301 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005302
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005303 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5304 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5305
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005306 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005307 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005308
5309 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005310 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005311
5312 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005313 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005314
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005315 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005316 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005317
5318
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005319http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005320 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5321 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005322 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5323 health checks.
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | no | yes | yes
5326 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005327 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5328
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005329 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5330 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5331 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5332 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5333 to invent non-standard ones.
5334
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005335 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5336 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5337 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5338 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5339
5340 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5341 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5342 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5343 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005344
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005345 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005346 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005347 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005348 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5349 to add it.
5350
5351 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5352 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5353 to the log-format rules.
5354
5355 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5356 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5357 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005358
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005359 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5360 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5361 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5362 request.
5363
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005364 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5365 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5366 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005367 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5368 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5369 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5370 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005371 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005372 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005373 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5374
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005375 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5376 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005377 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5378 so, it will be ignored.
5379
5380 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5381 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5382 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5383 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5384 configured request authority.
5385
5386 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5387 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005388
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005389 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005390
5391
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005392http-check send-state
5393 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 yes | no | yes | yes
5396 Arguments : none
5397
5398 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5399 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5400 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5401 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5402 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5403
5404 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5405 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5406 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5407 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5408 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005409 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5410 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5411 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5412
5413 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5414 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5415 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5416
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005417 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5418 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5419 checked in multiple backends.
5420
5421 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5422 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5423
5424 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5425 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5426 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5427 one fails.
5428
5429 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5430 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5431 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5432
5433 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5434 server's queue.
5435
5436 Example of a header received by the application server :
5437 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5438 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5439
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005440 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5441 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005442
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005443
5444http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005445 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5447 yes | no | yes | yes
5448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005450 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5451 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5452 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5453 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5454 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5455 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5456 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5457 and '-'.
5458
5459 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5460
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005461 Examples :
5462 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005463
5464
5465http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | no | yes | yes
5469
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005470 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5472 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5475 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5476 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5477 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5478 and '-'.
5479
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005480 Examples :
5481 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005483
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005484http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5485 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5486 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5487 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5488 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 yes | yes | yes | yes
5491 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005492 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005493 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005494 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5495 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005496
5497 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5498 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5499 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5500 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5501
5502 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5503 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5504 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5505 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5506
5507 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5508 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5509 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5510 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5511 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5512 chroot is performed.
5513
5514 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5515 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5516 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5517 considered.
5518
5519 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5520 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5521 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5522 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5523 considered as a raw string.
5524
5525 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5526 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5527 "content-type".
5528
5529 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5530 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5531 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5532 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5533 evaluated as a log-format string.
5534
5535 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5536 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5537 argument to "content-type".
5538
5539 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5540 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5541 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5542 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5543
5544 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5545 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5546 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5547 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5548 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5549 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5550 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5551 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5552
5553 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5554 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5555 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5556
5557 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5558 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5559
5560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005561http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005562 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5563
5564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 no | yes | yes | yes
5566
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005567 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5568 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5569 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5570 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5571 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005573 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5574 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005578 Example:
5579 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5580 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5581 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 http-request allow if nagios
5584 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5585 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5586 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005588 Example:
5589 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5590 acl add path /addacl
5591 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005595 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5596 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 Example:
5599 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5600 acl setmap path /setmap
5601 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005603 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005605 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5606 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005608 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5609 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5614 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5615 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5616 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5617 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5618 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5619 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5620 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005624 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5625 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5626 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5627 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5628 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5629 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5630 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5631 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005633http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005635 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5636 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005639http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5642 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5643 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5644 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5645 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005646
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005647 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5648 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5649 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5650 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5651 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5652 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5653 instead.
5654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005655 Example:
5656 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5657 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005658
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005659http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005660
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005661 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005663http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005666 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5667 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5668 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5669 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5670 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5671 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5672 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5673 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5674 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005676 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5677 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5678 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005679 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5680
5681 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5682 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5683 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5684 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005686http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005688 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5689 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5690 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5691 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5692 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5693 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005694
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005695http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005696
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005697 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5698 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5699 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5700 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5701 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005703http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005705 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5706 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5707 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5708 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5709 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5710 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005711
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005712http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5713http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5714 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5715 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5716 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005718
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005719 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5720 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5721 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005722 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005723 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5724 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5725 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005727 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005728
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005729http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5730 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5731 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5732 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5733
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005734http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5735
5736 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5737 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5738 pointed by <resolvers>.
5739 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5740 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5741 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5742 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5743 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5744 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5745 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5746 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5747 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5748 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5749 to 0.0.0.0.
5750
5751 Example:
5752 resolvers mydns
5753 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5754 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5755 timeout retry 1s
5756 hold valid 10s
5757 hold nx 3s
5758 hold other 3s
5759 hold obsolete 0s
5760 accepted_payload_size 8192
5761
5762 frontend fe
5763 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5764 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5765 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5766
5767 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5768 # which mean DNS resolution error
5769 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5770
5771 default_backend be
5772
5773 backend b_503
5774 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5775 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5776 # 503 error page to end users
5777
5778 backend be
5779 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5780 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5781 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5782 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5783 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5784
5785 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5786 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5787
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005788http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5789
5790 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5791 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5792 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5793 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005794 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5795 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005796
5797 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005801 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5802 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5803 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5804 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5805 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5810 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5811 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5812 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005814http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5815 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005816
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005817 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005818 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5819 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5820 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5821 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5822 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005823
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005824 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5825 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5826 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5827 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5828 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005829
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005830 Example:
5831 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5832
5833 # applied to:
5834 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5835
5836 # outputs:
5837 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5838
5839 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005840
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005841 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5842
5843 # applied to:
5844 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005845
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005846 # outputs:
5847 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005848
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005849http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5850 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5851
5852 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5853 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005854 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5855 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5856 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005857
5858 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5859 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5860 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5861
5862 Example:
5863 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5864 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5865
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005866 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5867 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5868 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5869 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5870
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005871http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5873
5874 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5875 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5876 query-string are replaced.
5877
5878 Example:
5879 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5880 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5881
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005882http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5883 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5884
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005885 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5886 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5887 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5888 against.
5889
5890 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5891 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5892 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005893
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005894 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5895 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5896 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5897 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5898 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5899 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5900 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5901 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5902 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005903 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5904 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005905
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005906 Example:
5907 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5908 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005909
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005910 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5911 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005913http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005915
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005916 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5917 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5918 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5919 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005920
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005921 Example:
5922 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005923
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005924 # applied to:
5925 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005926
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005927 # outputs:
5928 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005929
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005930http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5931 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5932 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005933 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005934 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5935
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005936 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005937 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5938 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005939 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005940 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005941 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005942 are followed to create the response :
5943
5944 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5945 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5946 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5947 ignored.
5948
5949 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5950 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005951 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005952 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5953 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005954
5955 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5956 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5957 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005958 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005959 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005960
5961 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5962 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5963 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005964 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005965 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5966 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005967
5968 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5969 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5970 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5971 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5972 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5973 as a raw content.
5974
5975 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5976 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5977 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5978 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5979 considered as a raw string.
5980
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005981 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005982 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5983 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5984 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5985
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005986 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5987 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005988 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005989
5990 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5991
5992 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005993 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005994 if { path /ping }
5995
5996 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5997 if { path /favicon.ico }
5998
5999 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6000 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6001 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006006 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6007 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6008 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006009
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006010http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6011 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006012
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006013 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6014 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6015 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6016 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6021 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6022 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6023 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6024 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 Arguments:
6027 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6028 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 Example:
6031 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6032 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6035 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6040 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6041 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 Arguments:
6044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6045 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006047 Example:
6048 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6049 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6052 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6053 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6058 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6059 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6060 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6061 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063 Example:
6064 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6065 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6066 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6067 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6068 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6069 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6070 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6071 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6072 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006074http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6077 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6078 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6079 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6080 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6083 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6086 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6087 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6088 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6089 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6090 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6091 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6092 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6093 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6098 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6099 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6100 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6101 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6102 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6103 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006105http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6108 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6109 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6114 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6115 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6116 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6117 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6118 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6119 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6120 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006122http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6125 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6126 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6127 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6128 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6129 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131 Example :
6132 # prepend the host name before the path
6133 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006134
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006135http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6136
6137 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6138 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6139 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006141http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006143 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6144 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6145 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6146 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6147 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6152 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6153 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6154 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6155 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6156 values have higher priority.
6157 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6158 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6159 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6160 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6161 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006165 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6166 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6167 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6168 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6169 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6170 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6171 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006174
6175 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006176 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6177 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6180 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6181 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6182 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006183 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6184 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006185
6186 Arguments :
6187 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6188 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006189
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006190 See also "option forwardfor".
6191
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006192 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006193 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6194 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6195
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006196 # After the masking this will track connections
6197 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6198 http-request track-sc0 src
6199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6201 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6202
6203http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6204
6205 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6206 expression.
6207
6208 Arguments:
6209 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6210 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006211
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006212 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006213 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6214 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6215
6216 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6217 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6218 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6219
6220http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6221
6222 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6223 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6224 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6225 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6226 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6227 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6228 information from the request.
6229
6230 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6231
6232http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6233
6234 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6235 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6236 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6237 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6238 path and the query string.
6239 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6240
6241http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6242
6243 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6244 inline.
6245
6246 Arguments:
6247 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6248 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6251 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6252 (request and response)
6253 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6254 processing
6255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6256 processing
6257 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6258 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6259 and '_'.
6260
6261 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6262 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006263
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006264 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006265 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006270 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6271 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6272 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6273 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6274 agent name must be used.
6275
6276 Arguments:
6277 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6278
6279 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6280 configuration.
6281
6282http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6283
6284 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6285 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6286 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6287 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6288 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6289 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6290 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6291 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6292 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6293 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6294 action.
6295 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6296 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6297 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6298 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6299 you fully understand how it works.
6300
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006301http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6302
6303 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6304 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6305 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6306 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6307 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006308 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006309 processing.
6310
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006311 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006312 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6313 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6314 rules evaluation.
6315
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006316http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6317http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6318 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6319 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6320 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006322
6323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6324 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6325 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006326 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6327 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6328 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6329 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6330 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6331 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6332 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6333 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6334 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6335 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006336 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006337 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6338 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6339 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6340 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6341 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006342
6343http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6344http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6345http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6346
6347 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6348 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6349 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6350 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006351 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006352 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6353 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6354 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6355 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6356 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6357 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6358 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6359
6360 Arguments :
6361 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6362 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6363 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6364 select which table entry to update the counters.
6365
6366 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6367 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6368 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6369 that table until the session ends.
6370
6371 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6372 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6373 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6374 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6375 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6376 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6377 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6378 useful information.
6379
6380 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6381 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6382 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6383 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6384 checks that make use of it.
6385
6386http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6387
6388 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006389
6390 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006391 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006392
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006393http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6394
6395 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6396 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6397 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6398 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6399 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6400 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6401
6402 Arguments :
6403 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6404
6405 Example:
6406 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006408http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006410 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6411 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6412 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006413
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006415http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006416 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6417
6418 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 no | yes | yes | yes
6420
6421 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6422 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6423 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6424 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6425 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6426 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006428 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6429 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006431 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006433 Example:
6434 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006438 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6439 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 Example:
6442 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006446 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6447 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6450 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006452http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006453
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006454 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6455 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6456 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6457 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6458 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6459 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6460 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6461 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006463http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006465 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6466 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6467 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6468 example, or to pass some internal information.
6469 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6470 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6471 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006472
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006473http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006474
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006475 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6476 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006477
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006478http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006479
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006480 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006482http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006483
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006484 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6485 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6486 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6487 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6488 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6489 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6490 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006492 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6493 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6494 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6495 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6496 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006497
6498 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6499 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6500 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6501 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006503http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006505 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6506 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6507 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6508 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6509 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6510 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006511
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006512http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006513
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006514 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6515 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6516 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6517 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6518 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006520http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006521
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006522 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6523 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6524 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6525 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6526 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6527 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006528
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006529http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6530http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6531 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6532 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6533 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6534 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006535
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006536 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6537 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6538 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006539 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006540 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6541 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6542 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006543 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006544 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006545
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006546http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006547
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006548 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6549 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6550 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6551 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6552 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6553 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006554
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006555http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6556 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006557
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006558 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6559 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006560
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006561 Example:
6562 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006563
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006564 # applied to:
6565 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006567 # outputs:
6568 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006569
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006570 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006572http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006575 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006576 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006577
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006578 Example:
6579 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006580
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006581 # applied to:
6582 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006584 # outputs:
6585 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006586
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006587http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6588 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6589 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006590 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006591 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6592
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006593 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006594 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6595 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006596 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006597 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006598 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006599 are followed to create the response :
6600
6601 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6602 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6603 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6604 ignored.
6605
6606 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6607 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006608 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006609 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6610 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006611
6612 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6613 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6614 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006615 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006616 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006617
6618 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6619 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6620 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006621 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006622 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6623 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006624
6625 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6626 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6627 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6628 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6629 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6630 as a raw content.
6631
6632 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6633 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6634 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6635 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6636 considered as a raw string.
6637
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006638 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6639 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6640 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6641 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6642
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006643 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6644 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006645 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006646
6647 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6648
6649 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006650 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006651 if { status eq 404 }
6652
6653 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6654 string "This is the end !" \
6655 if { status eq 500 }
6656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006657http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6658http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006660 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6661 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6662 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006663
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006664http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6665 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006666
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006667 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6668 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6669 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6670 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006672http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006673
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006674 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6675 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6676 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6677 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6678 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006680 Arguments:
6681 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006683 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6684 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006686http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006688 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6689 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6690 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006692http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693
6694 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6695 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6696 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6697 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6698 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6699
6700http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6701
6702 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6703 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6704 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6705 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6706 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6707 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6708 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6709 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6710 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6711
6712http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6713
6714 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6715 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6716 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6717 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6718 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6719 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6720 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6721
6722http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6723
6724 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6725 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6726 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6727 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6728 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6729 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6730 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6731 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6732
6733http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6735
6736 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6737 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6738 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6739 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006740
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006741 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006742 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6743 http-response set-status 431
6744 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6745 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006746
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006747http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006749 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6750 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6751 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6752 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6753 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6754 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6755 based on some information from the request.
6756
6757 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6758
6759http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6760
6761 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6762 inline.
6763
6764 Arguments:
6765 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6766 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6767 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6768 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6769 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6770 (request and response)
6771 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6772 processing
6773 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6774 processing
6775 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6776 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6777 and '_'.
6778
6779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6780 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006781
6782 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006783 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006785http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006787 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6788 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6789 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6790 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6791 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6792 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6793 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6794 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6795 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6796 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6797 action.
6798 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6799 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6800 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6801 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6802 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006803
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006804http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6805
6806 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6807 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6808 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6809 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6810 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006811 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006812 processing.
6813
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006814 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006815 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006816 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006817 rules evaluation.
6818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006819http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6821http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006823 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6824 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6825 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6826 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6827 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6828 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6829
6830http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6831
6832 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6833 about <var-name>.
6834
6835 Example:
6836 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6837
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006838
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006839http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6840 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6841
6842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | no | yes | yes
6844
6845 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006846 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6847 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6848 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006849
6850 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6851
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006852 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6853 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6854 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6855 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6856 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6857 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6858 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6859 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6860 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6861 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006862
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006863 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6864 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6865 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6866 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6867 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6868 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6869 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006870 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6871 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6872 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6873 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6874 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6875 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006876
6877 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6878 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6879 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6880 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6881 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6882 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6883 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6884 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006885 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006886 downsides of rare connection failures.
6887
6888 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6889 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6890 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6891 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6892 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6893 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006894 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006895 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6896 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6897 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6898 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6899 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6900
6901 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006902 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6903 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6904 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006905
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006906 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6907 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6908 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006909
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006910 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6911 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006912
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006913 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006914
6915 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6916 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6917 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6918
6919 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6920
6921
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006922http-send-name-header [<header>]
6923 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006926 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006927 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6928
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006929 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6930 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6931 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6932 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6933 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6934 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6935 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6936 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6937 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6938 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6939 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6940 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6941 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6942 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6943 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6944 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006945
6946 See also : "server"
6947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006948id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006949 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 no | yes | yes | yes
6952 Arguments : none
6953
6954 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6955 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6956 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006957
6958
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006959ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6960 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006962 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006963
6964 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6965 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6966 and running).
6967
6968 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6969 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6970 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006971 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006972 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6973
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006974 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6975 "unless" condition is met.
6976
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006977 Example:
6978 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6979 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6980 ignore-persist if url_static
6981
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006982 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6983
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006984load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6985 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 yes | no | yes | yes
6988
6989 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6990 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6991 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006992 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006993 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6994 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6995 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6996 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6997
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006998 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006999 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007000 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007001
7002 Arguments:
7003 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7004 named "server-state-file".
7005
7006 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7007 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7008 name is used as a file name.
7009
7010 none don't load any stat for this backend
7011
7012 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007013 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7014 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7015 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007016 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007017 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007018
7019 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7020 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7021
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007022 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007023
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007024 global
7025 stats socket /tmp/socket
7026 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007027
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007028 defaults
7029 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007031 backend bk
7032 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7033 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007034
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007035
7036 Then one can run :
7037
7038 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7039
7040 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7041
7042 1
7043 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7044 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7045 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7046
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007047 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007048
7049 global
7050 stats socket /tmp/socket
7051 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7052
7053 defaults
7054 load-server-state-from-file local
7055
7056 backend bk
7057 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7058 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7059
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007060
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007061 Then one can run :
7062
7063 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7064
7065 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7066
7067 1
7068 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7069 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7070 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7071
7072 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7073 "show servers state"
7074
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007076log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007077log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7078 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007079no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007080 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7082 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007083
7084 Prefix :
7085 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7086 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7087 prefix does not allow arguments.
7088
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007089 Arguments :
7090 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7091 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7092 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7093 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7094 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7095 parameter.
7096
7097 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7098 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7099
7100 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7101 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7102 standard syslog port).
7103
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007104 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7105 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7106 standard syslog port).
7107
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007108 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7109 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7110 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007111 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007112
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007113 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7114 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7115 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7116 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7117 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7118 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7119 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7120 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7121 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7122 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7123 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7124 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7125 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7126 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7127 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7128 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007129 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7130 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007131
7132 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7133 and "fd@2", see above.
7134
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007135 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7136 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7137 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7138 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7139 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7140 having the logs instantly available.
7141
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007142 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7143 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007144
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007145 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7146 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7147 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7148 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7149 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7150 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7151 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7152 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7153 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7154 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007155 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007156
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007157 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7158 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7159 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7160 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7161 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7162
7163 <sample_size>
7164 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7165 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7166 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7167 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7168 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7169
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007170 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7171 one of the following :
7172
7173 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
7174 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7175
7176 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7177 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7178
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007179 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7180 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7181 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7182 designed to be used with a local log server.
7183
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007184 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7185 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7186 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7187 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7188 systemd logger consumes.
7189
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007190 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7191 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7192 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7193 used with a local log server.
7194
7195 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7196 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7197 designed to be used with a local log server.
7198
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007199 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7200 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7201 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7202 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7203
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007204 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7205
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007206 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7207 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7208 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7209
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007210 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7211 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7212 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7213 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007214
7215 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7216 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7217 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007218 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7219 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7220 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7221 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7222 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007223
7224 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7225
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007226 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7227 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7228 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007229
7230 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7231 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7232 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7233 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7234
7235 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7236 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007237
7238 Example :
7239 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007240 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7241 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7242 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007243 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7244 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007245 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007246
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007247
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007248log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007249 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007252
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007253 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7254 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7255 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7256 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7257 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007258
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007259 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7260 "option httplog" directives.
7261
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007262log-format-sd <string>
7263 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 yes | yes | yes | no
7266
7267 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7268 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7269 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7270 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7271 which covers the log format string in depth.
7272
7273 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7274 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7275
7276 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7277 log format to "rfc5424".
7278
7279 Example :
7280 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7281
7282
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007283log-tag <string>
7284 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7286 yes | yes | yes | yes
7287
7288 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7289 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7290 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7291 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7292 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7293 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7294 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7295 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7296 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007297
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007298max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7299 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 yes | no | yes | yes
7302
7303 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7304 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7305 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7306 servers.
7307
7308 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7309 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7310 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7311 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7312 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007314 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7315 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7316 picking a different server.
7317
7318 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7319 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7320 even if they have to be queued.
7321
7322 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7323 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7324
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007325max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7326 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7327 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7328 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007330maxconn <conns>
7331 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7333 yes | yes | yes | no
7334 Arguments :
7335 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7336 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7337 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7338 closes.
7339
7340 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7341 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7342 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7343 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007344 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7345 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7346 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7347 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007348
7349 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7350 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7351 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7352
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007353 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7354 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007355
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007356 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7357
7358
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007359mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007360 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7362 yes | yes | yes | yes
7363 Arguments :
7364 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7365 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7366 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7367 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7368
7369 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7370 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7371 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7372 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7373 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7374
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007375 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7376 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7377 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007378
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007379 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007380 defaults http_instances
7381 mode http
7382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007384monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007385 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7387 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007388 Arguments :
7389 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7390 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007391 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007392 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7393 backend and its backup.
7394
7395 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7396 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7397 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7398 servers in a list of backends.
7399
7400 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7401 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7402 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7403 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7404 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7405 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7406 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007407 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7408 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007409
7410 Example:
7411 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007412 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007413 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7414 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7415 monitor-uri /site_alive
7416 monitor fail if site_dead
7417
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007418 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007419
7420
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007421monitor-uri <uri>
7422 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7424 yes | yes | yes | no
7425 Arguments :
7426 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7427 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7428
7429 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7430 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7431 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7432 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7433 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7434 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7435 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7436 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7437
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007438 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007439 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7440 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7441 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7442 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7443 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7444 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007445
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007446 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7447 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7448 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7449 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7450
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007451 Example :
7452 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7453 frontend www
7454 mode http
7455 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7456
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007457 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007459
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007460option abortonclose
7461no option abortonclose
7462 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 yes | no | yes | yes
7465 Arguments : none
7466
7467 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7468 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7469 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7470 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007471 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007472 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7473 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7474 encountered while delivering the response.
7475
7476 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7477 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7478 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7479 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7480 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7481 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007482 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007483 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007484 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007485 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7486 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7487 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007489 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7490 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007491 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7492 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7493 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7494 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7495 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7496 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007497 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007498
7499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7501
7502 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7503
7504
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007505option accept-invalid-http-request
7506no option accept-invalid-http-request
7507 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 yes | yes | yes | no
7510 Arguments : none
7511
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007512 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007513 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007514 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007515 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7516 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7517 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7518 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7519 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007520 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7521 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7522 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7523 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007524 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007525 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007526 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7527 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7528 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007529
7530 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7531 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7532 been confirmed.
7533
7534 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7535 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007536 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7537 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007538 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7539
7540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7542
7543 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7544 stats socket.
7545
7546
7547option accept-invalid-http-response
7548no option accept-invalid-http-response
7549 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552 Arguments : none
7553
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007554 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007555 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007556 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007557 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7558 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7559 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7560 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7561 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007562 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7563 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7564 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007565
7566 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7567 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7568 been confirmed.
7569
7570 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7571 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7572 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7573 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7574
7575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7577
7578 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7579 stats socket.
7580
7581
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007582option allbackups
7583no option allbackups
7584 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7586 yes | no | yes | yes
7587 Arguments : none
7588
7589 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7590 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7591 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7592 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7593 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7594 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7595 order between the backup servers anymore.
7596
7597 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7598 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7599
7600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7602
7603
7604option checkcache
7605no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007606 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7608 yes | no | yes | yes
7609 Arguments : none
7610
7611 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7612 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007613 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007614 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7615 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007616 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007617
7618 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007619 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007620 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007621 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7622 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007623 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007624 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007625 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7626 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007627 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007628 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7629 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007630 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007631 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7632 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7633 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7634 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7635 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7636 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7637 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7638 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7639 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7640
7641 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007642 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7643 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7644 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7645 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007646
7647 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7648 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007649 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007650 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007651
7652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7654
7655
7656option clitcpka
7657no option clitcpka
7658 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 yes | yes | yes | no
7661 Arguments : none
7662
7663 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7664 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007665 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007666 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7667
7668 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7669 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7670 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7671 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7672
7673 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7674 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7675 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7676 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7677 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7678
7679 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7680
7681 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7682 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7683 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7684
7685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7687
7688 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7689
7690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007691option contstats
7692 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | yes | yes | no
7695 Arguments : none
7696
7697 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7698 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7699 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7700 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007701 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7702 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7703 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7704 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7705 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007706
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007707option disable-h2-upgrade
7708no option disable-h2-upgrade
7709 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7710 connection.
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | yes | yes | no
7713 Arguments : none
7714
7715 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7716 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7717 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7718 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7719 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7720 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7721 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7722 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7723
7724 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7725 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007726
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007727option dontlog-normal
7728no option dontlog-normal
7729 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | no
7732 Arguments : none
7733
7734 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7735 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7736 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7737 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7738 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7739 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7740 logged.
7741
7742 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7743 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7744 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007746 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007747 logging.
7748
7749
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007750option dontlognull
7751no option dontlognull
7752 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7754 yes | yes | yes | no
7755 Arguments : none
7756
7757 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7758 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7759 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7760 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7761 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7762 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007763 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7764 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7765 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007766
7767 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007768 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007769 would not be logged.
7770
7771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7773
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007774 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007775 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007776
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007777
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007778option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007779 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7781 yes | yes | yes | yes
7782 Arguments :
7783 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7784 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007785 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007786 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007787
7788 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7789 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7790 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7791 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7792 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7793 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7794 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007795 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7796 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7797 possible that the client has already brought one.
7798
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007799 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007800 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007801 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007802 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007803 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007804 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007805
7806 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7807 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7808 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7809 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7810 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7811 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7812 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7813
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007814 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7815 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7816 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7817 are under the control of the end-user.
7818
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007819 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007820 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7821 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007822 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7823 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7824 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007825
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007826 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007827 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7828 frontend www
7829 mode http
7830 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7831
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007832 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7833 backend www
7834 mode http
7835 option forwardfor header X-Client
7836
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007837 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007838 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007839
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007840
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007841option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7842no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7843 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | yes | yes | no
7846 Arguments : none
7847
7848 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7849 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7850 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7851 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7852 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7853 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7854 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7855
7856 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7857 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7858 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7859 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7860 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7861 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7862 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7863 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7864 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7865 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7866
7867 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7868
7869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7871
7872 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7873 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7874
7875
7876option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7877no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7878 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | no | yes | yes
7881 Arguments : none
7882
7883 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7884 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7885 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7886 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7887 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7888 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7889 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7890
7891 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7892 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7893 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7894 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7895 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7896 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7897 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7898 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7899 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7900 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7901
7902 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7903
7904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7906
7907 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7908 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7909
7910
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007911option http-buffer-request
7912no option http-buffer-request
7913 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | yes | yes | yes
7916 Arguments : none
7917
7918 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7919 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7920 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7921 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7922 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7923 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007924 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7925 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7926 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7927 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007928
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007929 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007930
7931
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007932option http-ignore-probes
7933no option http-ignore-probes
7934 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | yes | yes | no
7937 Arguments : none
7938
7939 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7940 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7941 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7942 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7943 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7944 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7945 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7946 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7947 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007948 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7949 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007950 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7951
7952 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7953 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7954 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7955 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7956 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7957 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7958 are often the only way to detect them.
7959
7960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7962
7963 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7964
7965
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007966option http-keep-alive
7967no option http-keep-alive
7968 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 yes | yes | yes | yes
7971 Arguments : none
7972
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007973 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7974 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007975 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7976 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007977 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7978 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7979 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007980
7981 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7982 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007983 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7984 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7985 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7986 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7987 situations where this option may be useful :
7988
7989 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007990 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007991
7992 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7993 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7994
7995 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7996 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7997 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7998 request.
7999
8000 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8001 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008002 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8003 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8004 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008005
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008006 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8007 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8008 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8009 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8010 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8011 not set.
8012
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008013 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8014 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8015 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008016
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008017 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008018 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008019 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008020
8021
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008022option http-no-delay
8023no option http-no-delay
8024 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 yes | yes | yes | yes
8027 Arguments : none
8028
8029 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8030 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8031 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8032 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8033 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8034 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8035 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8036 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8037 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8038 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8039 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8040 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8041 affected.
8042
8043 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8044 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8045 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8046 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8047 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8048 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8049 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8050 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8051 latency environments.
8052
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008053 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8054
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008055
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008056option http-pretend-keepalive
8057no option http-pretend-keepalive
8058 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008060 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008061 Arguments : none
8062
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008063 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008064 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8065 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8066 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8067 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8068 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8069 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8070 consider the response complete.
8071
8072 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8073 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8074 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8075 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008076 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008077 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8078
8079 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8080 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8081 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8082 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8083 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8084 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8085 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8086
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008087 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8088 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8089 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8090 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8091 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8092 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008093
8094 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8095 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8096
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008097 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008098 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008099
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008100
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008101option http-server-close
8102no option http-server-close
8103 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8105 yes | yes | yes | yes
8106 Arguments : none
8107
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008108 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8109 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8110 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8111 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008112 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8113 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8114 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8115 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8116 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8117 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8118 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8119 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8120 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8121 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8122 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008123
8124 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8125 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8126 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8127 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008128 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8129 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008130
8131 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8132 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008133 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8134 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8135 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008136
8137 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8138 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8139
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008140 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8141 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008142
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008143option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008144no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008145 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8147 yes | yes | yes | no
8148 Arguments : none
8149
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008150 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008151 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8152 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8153 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8154 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8155 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8156 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8157
8158 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8159 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008160 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8161 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8162 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008163
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008164 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8165 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8166 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8167 front of an existing proxy.
8168
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008169 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8170
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008171 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008172
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008173option httpchk
8174option httpchk <uri>
8175option httpchk <method> <uri>
8176option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008177 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 yes | no | yes | yes
8180 Arguments :
8181 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8182 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8183 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8184 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8185 ones.
8186
8187 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8188 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8189 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8190
8191 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8192 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8193 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008194 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008195
8196 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8197 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8198 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8199 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8200 the lack of any response.
8201
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008202 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8203 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8204 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8205 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8206
8207 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8208 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8209 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008210
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008211 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8212 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008213 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008214 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008215 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008217 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8218 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8219 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8220 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8221
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008222 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008223 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8224 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8225 backend https_relay
8226 mode tcp
8227 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8228 http-check send hdr Host www
8229 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008230
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008231 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8232 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8233 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234
8235
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008236option httpclose
8237no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008238 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 yes | yes | yes | yes
8241 Arguments : none
8242
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008243 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8244 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8245 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8246 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008247 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008248
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008249 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8250 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008251 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008252 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8253 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008254
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008255 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8256 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8257 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008258
8259 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8260 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008261 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8262 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8263 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008264
8265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8267
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008268 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008269
8270
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008271option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008272 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008274 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008275 Arguments :
8276 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8277 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8278 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008279 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008280 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008281
8282 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8283 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8284 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8285 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8286 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8287 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8288 ports.
8289
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008290 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8291 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008292
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008293 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008295 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008296
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008297
8298option http_proxy
8299no option http_proxy
8300 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8302 yes | yes | yes | yes
8303 Arguments : none
8304
8305 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8306 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8307 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8308 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8309 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8310
8311 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8312 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008313 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8314 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008315
8316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8318
8319 Example :
8320 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8321 backend direct_forward
8322 option httpclose
8323 option http_proxy
8324
8325 See also : "option httpclose"
8326
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008327
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008328option independent-streams
8329no option independent-streams
8330 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8332 yes | yes | yes | yes
8333 Arguments : none
8334
8335 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8336 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8337 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8338 receive data or not.
8339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008340 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008341 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8342 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8343 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8344 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8345 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8346 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8347 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8348 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8349 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8350 socket buffers.
8351
8352 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8353 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8354 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8355 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8356 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8357
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008358 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008359
8360
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008361option ldap-check
8362 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | no | yes | yes
8365 Arguments : none
8366
8367 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8368 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8369 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8370 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8371
8372 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8373 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8374
8375 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8376 configure it.
8377
8378 Example :
8379 option ldap-check
8380
8381 See also : "option httpchk"
8382
8383
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008384option external-check
8385 Use external processes for server health checks
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | no | yes | yes
8388
8389 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8390 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8391 command".
8392
8393 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8394
8395 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8396
8397
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008398option log-health-checks
8399no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008400 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8402 yes | no | yes | yes
8403 Arguments : none
8404
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008405 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8406 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8407 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008408
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008409 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8410 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8411 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8412 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8413 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8414
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008415 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008416 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008417
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008418 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8419 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8420 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008421
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008422
8423option log-separate-errors
8424no option log-separate-errors
8425 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 yes | yes | yes | no
8428 Arguments : none
8429
8430 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8431 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8432 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8433 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8434 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8435 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8436 provides very important information.
8437
8438 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8439 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8440 error logs.
8441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008442 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008443 logging.
8444
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008445
8446option logasap
8447no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008448 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | yes | yes | no
8451 Arguments : none
8452
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008453 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8454 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8455 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8456 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8457
8458 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8459 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8460 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8461 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8462 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008463 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008464 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8465 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8466 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8467 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008468 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008470 Examples :
8471 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8472 mode http
8473 option httplog
8474 option logasap
8475 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8476
8477 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8478 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8479 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8480 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008482 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008483 logging.
8484
8485
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008486option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008487 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008490 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008491 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8492 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008493 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8494 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008495
8496 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8497 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008498 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008499 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8500 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8501 in the MySQL table, like this :
8502
8503 USE mysql;
8504 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8505 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8506
8507 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008508 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008509 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8510 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8511 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8512 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8513 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8514 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8515 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8516
8517 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8518 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008519
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008520 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008521
8522 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8523 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8524 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8525 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008526 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8527 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008528
8529 See also: "option httpchk"
8530
8531
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008532option nolinger
8533no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008534 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008535 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008537 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008539 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008540 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8541 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8542 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8543 connections.
8544
8545 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8546 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008547 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8548 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8549 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8550 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8551 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8552 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8553 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8554 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8555 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8556 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8557 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8558 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8559 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008560
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008561 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8562 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8563 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8564 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8565 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008566
8567 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8568 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008569 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8570 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8571 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008572
8573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8575
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008576 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8577 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008578
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008579option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8580 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8582 yes | yes | yes | yes
8583 Arguments :
8584 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8585 matching <network>
8586 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8587 header name.
8588
8589 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8590 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8591 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8592 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8593 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8594 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8595 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8596 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8597 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8598 possible that the client has already brought one.
8599
8600 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8601 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8602 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8603 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8604 header and requires different one.
8605
8606 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8607 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8608 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8609 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8610 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8611 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8612 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8613
8614 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8615 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8616 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8617 both are defined.
8618
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008619 Examples :
8620 # Original Destination address
8621 frontend www
8622 mode http
8623 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8624
8625 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8626 backend www
8627 mode http
8628 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8629
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008630 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008631
8632
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008633option persist
8634no option persist
8635 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008639
8640 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8641 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8642 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8643 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8644 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8645 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8646 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8647 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8648 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8649 redirected to another valid server.
8650
8651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8653
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008654 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008655
8656
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008657option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8658 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8660 yes | no | yes | yes
8661 Arguments :
8662 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8663 PostgreSQL server.
8664
8665 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8666 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8667 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8668 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8669
8670 See also: "option httpchk"
8671
8672
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008673option prefer-last-server
8674no option prefer-last-server
8675 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8677 yes | no | yes | yes
8678 Arguments : none
8679
8680 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8681 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8682 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8683 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8684 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8685 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8686 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8687 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8688 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008689 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8690 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008691 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8692 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8693 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008694 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8695 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8696 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008697
8698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8700
8701 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8702
8703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008704option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008705option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008706no option redispatch
8707 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8709 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008710 Arguments :
8711 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8712 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8713 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008714 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008715 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008716 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008717 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8718 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8719 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008721
8722 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8723 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8724 be able to access the service anymore.
8725
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008726 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8727 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008728
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008729 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8730 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8731 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8732 following order:
8733
8734 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8735
8736 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8737 list, or
8738
8739 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8740
8741 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8742 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8743
8744 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8745 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8746 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8747 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8748
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008749 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008750 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8751 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8755
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008756 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008757
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008758
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008759option redis-check
8760 Use redis health checks for server testing
8761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8762 yes | no | yes | yes
8763 Arguments : none
8764
8765 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8766 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8767 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8768 find the "+PONG" response message.
8769
8770 Example :
8771 option redis-check
8772
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008773 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008774
8775
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008776option smtpchk
8777option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8778 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8780 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008781 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008782 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008783 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008784 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8785
8786 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8787 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8788 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8789
8790 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8791 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8792 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8793 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8794 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8795 dead server.
8796
8797 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8798 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008799 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008800 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8801
8802 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8803 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8804 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8805 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008806 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008807
8808 Example :
8809 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8810
8811 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008814option socket-stats
8815no option socket-stats
8816
8817 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8819 yes | yes | yes | no
8820
8821 Arguments : none
8822
8823
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008824option splice-auto
8825no option splice-auto
8826 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8828 yes | yes | yes | yes
8829 Arguments : none
8830
8831 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8832 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008833 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008834 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008835 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008836 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8837 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8838 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8839 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8840
8841 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8842 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8843 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8844 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8845 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8846 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8847 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8848 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8849 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8850 keyword.
8851
8852 Example :
8853 option splice-auto
8854
8855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8857
8858 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8859 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8860
8861
8862option splice-request
8863no option splice-request
8864 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 yes | yes | yes | yes
8867 Arguments : none
8868
8869 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008870 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008871 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8872 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8873 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8874 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8875
8876 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8877
8878 Example :
8879 option splice-request
8880
8881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8883
8884 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8885 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8886
8887
8888option splice-response
8889no option splice-response
8890 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 yes | yes | yes | yes
8893 Arguments : none
8894
8895 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008896 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008897 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8898 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8899 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8900 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8901
8902 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8903
8904 Example :
8905 option splice-response
8906
8907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8909
8910 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8911 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8912
8913
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008914option spop-check
8915 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8917 no | no | no | yes
8918 Arguments : none
8919
8920 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8921 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8922 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8923 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8924
8925 Example :
8926 option spop-check
8927
8928 See also : "option httpchk"
8929
8930
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008931option srvtcpka
8932no option srvtcpka
8933 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 yes | no | yes | yes
8936 Arguments : none
8937
8938 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8939 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008940 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008941 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8942
8943 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8944 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8945 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8946 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8947
8948 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8949 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8950 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8951 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8952 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8953
8954 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8955
8956 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8957 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8958 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8959
8960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8962
8963 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8964
8965
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008966option ssl-hello-chk
8967 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8969 yes | no | yes | yes
8970 Arguments : none
8971
8972 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8973 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8974 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8975 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8976 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8977 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8978 hello message.
8979
8980 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8981 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8982 messages, which is appreciable.
8983
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008984 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8985 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8986 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008987
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008988 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8989
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008990
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008991option tcp-check
8992 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8994 yes | no | yes | yes
8995
8996 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8997 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8998
8999 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9000 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9001 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9002
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009003 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009004 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9005 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9006 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9007 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9008 only.
9009
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009010 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009011 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9012 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9013 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9014 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9015
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009016 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009017 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9018 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009019 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009020 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9021 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9022 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9023 the respective protocols.
9024 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009025 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009026
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009027 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009028
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009029 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9030 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9031 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9032 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009034 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9035 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9036 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009037
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009038
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009039 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009040 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009041 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009042 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009044 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009045 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009046 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009047
9048 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9049 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009050 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009051 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009052 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009053 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009054 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009055 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009056 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9057 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009058 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009059 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9060 tcp-check expect string +OK
9061
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063 (send many headers before analyzing)
9064 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009065 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009066 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9067 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9068 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9069 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009070 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009071
9072
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009073 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009074
9075
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009076option tcp-smart-accept
9077no option tcp-smart-accept
9078 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9080 yes | yes | yes | no
9081 Arguments : none
9082
9083 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9084 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9085 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9086 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9087 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9088 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9089
9090 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9091 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9092 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9093 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9094
9095 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9096 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9097 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009098 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009099
9100 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9101 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9102 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9103
9104 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9105 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9106 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9107
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009108 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9109
9110
9111option tcp-smart-connect
9112no option tcp-smart-connect
9113 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 yes | no | yes | yes
9116 Arguments : none
9117
9118 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9119 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9120 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9121 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9122 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9123
9124 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9125 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9126 complex.
9127
9128 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9129 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9130 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9131
9132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9134
9135 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9136
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009137
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009138option tcpka
9139 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9141 yes | yes | yes | yes
9142 Arguments : none
9143
9144 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9145 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009146 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009147 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9148
9149 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9150 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9151 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9152 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9153
9154 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9155 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9156 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9157 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9158 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9159
9160 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9161
9162 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9163 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9164 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9165 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9166 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9167 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9168 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9169 backends.
9170
9171 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9172
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009173
9174option tcplog
9175 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009177 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009178 Arguments : none
9179
9180 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9181 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9182 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9183 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9184 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9185 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9186 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9187 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9188
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009189 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009191 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009192
9193
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009194option transparent
9195no option transparent
9196 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009198 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009199 Arguments : none
9200
9201 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9202 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9203 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9204 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9205 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9206 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9207 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9208 appropriate server.
9209
9210 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9211 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9212
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009213 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009214 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009215
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009216
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009217external-check command <command>
9218 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9220 yes | no | yes | yes
9221
9222 Arguments :
9223 <command> is the external command to run
9224
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009225 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9226
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009227 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009228
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009229 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9230 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9231 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9232 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9233 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9234 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009235
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009236 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9237
9238 Environment variables :
9239 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9240 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9241
9242 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9243
9244 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9245
9246 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9247 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9248 for a UNIX socket).
9249
9250 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9251
9252 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9253
9254 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9255
9256 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9257
9258 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9259
9260 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9261 socket).
9262
9263 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9264 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9265
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009266 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9267
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009268 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9269 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9270 failed.
9271
9272 Example :
9273 external-check command /bin/true
9274
9275 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9276
9277
9278external-check path <path>
9279 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9281 yes | no | yes | yes
9282
9283 Arguments :
9284 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9285
9286 The default path is "".
9287
9288 Example :
9289 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9290
9291 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9292 "external-check command"
9293
9294
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009295persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009296persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009297 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9299 yes | no | yes | yes
9300 Arguments :
9301 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009302 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9303 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009304
9305 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9306 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009307 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009308 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9309 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9310 forwarded to this server.
9311
9312 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9313 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9314 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009315 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009316 a single "listen" section.
9317
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009318 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9319 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9320 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9321
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009322 Example :
9323 listen tse-farm
9324 bind :3389
9325 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9326 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9327 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9328 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9329 persist rdp-cookie
9330 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009331 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009332 balance rdp-cookie
9333 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9334 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9335
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009336 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9337 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009338
9339
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009340rate-limit sessions <rate>
9341 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | yes | yes | no
9344 Arguments :
9345 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9346 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9347
9348 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9349 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9350 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9351 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9352 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9353 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9354
9355 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9356 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9357 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9358 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9359
9360 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9361 listen smtp
9362 mode tcp
9363 bind :25
9364 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009365 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009366
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009367 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9368 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9369 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009370
9371 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9372
9373
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009374redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9375redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9376redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009377 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 no | yes | yes | yes
9380
9381 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009382 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009383
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009384 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009385 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009386 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9387 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9388 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009389
9390 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9391 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9392 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9393 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9394 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009395 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9396 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9397 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9398 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009399
9400 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9401 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9402 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9403 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9404 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9405 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009406 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009407 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009408 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9409 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9410 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009411
9412 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009413 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9414 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9415 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009416 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009417 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9418 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9419 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9420 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009421
9422 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009423 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009424
9425 - "drop-query"
9426 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9427 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9428 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9429 with a location-type redirect.
9430
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009431 - "append-slash"
9432 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9433 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9434 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9435 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9436
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009437 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9438 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9439 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9440 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9441 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9442 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9443 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9444
9445 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9446 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9447 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9448 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9449 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9450 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9451 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009452
9453 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9454 acl clear dst_port 80
9455 acl secure dst_port 8080
9456 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009457 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009458 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009459 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9460
9461 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009462 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9463 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9464 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009465 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009466
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009467 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9468 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9469 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9470
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009471 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009472 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009473
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009474 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009475 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9476 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9477 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009479 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009480
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009481
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009482retries <value>
9483 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 yes | no | yes | yes
9486 Arguments :
9487 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9488 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9489 default value is 3.
9490
9491 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9492 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9493 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9494
9495 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009496 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9497 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009498
9499 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9500 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9501
9502 See also : "option redispatch"
9503
9504
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009505retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009506 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9507 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9508 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | no | yes | yes
9511 Arguments :
9512 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9513 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9514 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9515 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9516
9517 none never retry
9518
9519 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9520 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9521
9522 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9523 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9524 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9525 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9526 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9527 processing the request.
9528
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009529 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9530 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9531 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9532 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9533 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9534 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9535 overflow attack for example).
9536
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009537 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9538 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9539 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9540 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9541 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9542 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9543 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9544 amplify denial of service attacks.
9545
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009546 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9547 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9548 considered to be safe to retry.
9549
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009550 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9551 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9552 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9553 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9554 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009555
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009556 all-retryable-errors
9557 retry request for any error that are considered
9558 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9559 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9560 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9561
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009562 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9563 not cumulative.
9564
9565 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9566 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9567 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9568 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9569
9570 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9571 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9572 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9573 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9574 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9575 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9576 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9577 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9578 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9579 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9580 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9581 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9582
9583 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9584 should not use this directive.
9585
9586 The default is "conn-failure".
9587
9588 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9589
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009590server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009591 Declare a server in a backend
9592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9593 no | no | yes | yes
9594 Arguments :
9595 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009596 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009597 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009598
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009599 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9600 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9601 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9602 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009603 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9604 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9605 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9606 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9607 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009608 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9609 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9610 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9611 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9612 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9613 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9614 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009615 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009616 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9617 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9618 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9619 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9620 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9621 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009622 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9623 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009624 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9625 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009627 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009628 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9629 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9630 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9631 adding this value to the client's port.
9632
9633 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9634 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009635 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009636
9637 Examples :
9638 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9639 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009640 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009641 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9642 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9643 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009644
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009645 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9646 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9647 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9648 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9649 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9650
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009651 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9652 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009654server-state-file-name [<file>]
9655 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9656 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9657 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9658 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9659 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9660 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9661
9662 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9663 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9664
9665 global
9666 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9667
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009668 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009669 load-server-state-from-file
9670
9671 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9672 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009673
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009674server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9675 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9676 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 no | no | yes | yes
9679
9680 Arguments:
9681 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9682
9683 <num | range>
9684 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9685 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9686 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9687 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9688
9689 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9690
9691 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9692
9693 <params*>
9694 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9695 keyword.
9696
9697 Examples:
9698 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9699 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9700 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9701
9702 # or
9703 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9704
9705 # would be equivalent to:
9706 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9707 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9708 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9709
9710
9711
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009712source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009713source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009714source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009715 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9717 yes | no | yes | yes
9718 Arguments :
9719 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9720 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009722 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009723 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9724 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9725 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9726 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9727 supported prefixes are :
9728 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9729 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9730 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009731 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009732 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9733 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009734
9735 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9736 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009737 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9738 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9739 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009740
9741 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9742 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9743 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9744 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9745 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9746 <addr>.
9747
9748 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9749 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9750 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9751 port.
9752
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009753 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9754 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9755 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9756 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009757 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009758 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9759 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9760 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9761 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9762 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9763 HTTP header.
9764
9765 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9766 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009767 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009768 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9769 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9770 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9771 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9772 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9773 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9774 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9775
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009776 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9777 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9778 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9779 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9780 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9781 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9782
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009783 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9784 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9785 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9786 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9787
9788 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9789 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9790 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9791 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9792 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9793 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9794
9795 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9796 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9797 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9798 there are two methods :
9799
9800 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9801 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9802 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9803 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9804 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9805 of the client ranges may be used.
9806
9807 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9808 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9809 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9810 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9811 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9812 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9813 same session.
9814
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009815 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9816 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9817 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009818 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009819
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009820 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9821
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009822 Examples :
9823 backend private
9824 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9825 source 192.168.1.200
9826
9827 backend transparent_ssl1
9828 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9829 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9830
9831 backend transparent_ssl2
9832 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9833 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9834 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9835
9836 backend transparent_ssl3
9837 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9838 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9839 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9840
9841 backend transparent_smtp
9842 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9843 # with Tproxy version 4.
9844 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9845
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009846 backend transparent_http
9847 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9848 # proxy.
9849 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009851 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009852 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9853
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009854
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009855srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9856 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9857 the connection on the server side.
9858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9859 yes | no | yes | yes
9860 Arguments :
9861 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9862
9863 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9864 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009865 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9866 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009867
9868 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9869
9870
9871srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9872 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9873 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9874 server side.
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | no | yes | yes
9877 Arguments :
9878 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9879 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9880 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9881 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9882
9883 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9884 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009885 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9886 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009887
9888 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9889
9890
9891srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9892 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9894 yes | no | yes | yes
9895 Arguments :
9896 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9897 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9898 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9899 document.
9900
9901 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9902 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009903 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9904 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009905
9906 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9907
9908
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009909stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9910 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009912 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009913
9914 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9915 matched.
9916
9917 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9918 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9919
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009920 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9921 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009922 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009923
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009924 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9925 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9926 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9927 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009928
9929 Example :
9930 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9931 backend stats_localhost
9932 stats enable
9933 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9934
9935 Example :
9936 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9937 backend stats_auth
9938 stats enable
9939 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9940 stats admin if TRUE
9941
9942 Example :
9943 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9944 userlist stats-auth
9945 group admin users admin
9946 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9947 group readonly users haproxy
9948 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9949
9950 backend stats_auth
9951 stats enable
9952 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9953 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9954 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9955 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009957 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9958 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9959 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009960
9961
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009962stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9963 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009966 Arguments :
9967 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9968
9969 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9970
9971 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9972 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9973 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9974 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9975 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9976 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9977
9978 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9979 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9980 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009981 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009982
9983 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9984 report using "stats scope".
9985
9986 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9987 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9988 unobvious parameters.
9989
9990 Example :
9991 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9992 backend public_www
9993 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9994 stats enable
9995 stats hide-version
9996 stats scope .
9997 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009998 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009999 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10000 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10001
10002 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10003 backend private_monitoring
10004 stats enable
10005 stats uri /admin?stats
10006 stats refresh 5s
10007
10008 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10009
10010
10011stats enable
10012 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010014 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010015 Arguments : none
10016
10017 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10018 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10019 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10020 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10021 - stats auth : no authentication
10022 - stats scope : no restriction
10023
10024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10026 unobvious parameters.
10027
10028 Example :
10029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10030 backend public_www
10031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10032 stats enable
10033 stats hide-version
10034 stats scope .
10035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10039
10040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10041 backend private_monitoring
10042 stats enable
10043 stats uri /admin?stats
10044 stats refresh 5s
10045
10046 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10047
10048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010049stats hide-version
10050 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010053 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010054
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010055 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10056 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10057 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10058 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10059 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10060 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010062 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10063 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10064 unobvious parameters.
10065
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010066 Example :
10067 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10068 backend public_www
10069 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010070 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071 stats hide-version
10072 stats scope .
10073 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010074 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010075 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10076 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010077
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010078 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10079 backend private_monitoring
10080 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010081 stats uri /admin?stats
10082 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010083
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010084 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010085
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010086
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010087stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10089 Access control for statistics
10090
10091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10092 no | no | yes | yes
10093
10094 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10095 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10096 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10097 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10098 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10099 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10100
10101 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10102 instance.
10103
10104 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10105 about ACL usage.
10106
10107
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010108stats realm <realm>
10109 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010112 Arguments :
10113 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10114 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10115 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10116
10117 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10118 using a backslash ('\').
10119
10120 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10121 only related to authentication.
10122
10123 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10124 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10125 unobvious parameters.
10126
10127 Example :
10128 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10129 backend public_www
10130 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10131 stats enable
10132 stats hide-version
10133 stats scope .
10134 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010135 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010136 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10137 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10138
10139 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10140 backend private_monitoring
10141 stats enable
10142 stats uri /admin?stats
10143 stats refresh 5s
10144
10145 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10146
10147
10148stats refresh <delay>
10149 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010151 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010152 Arguments :
10153 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10154 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10155 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10156 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10157 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10158 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10159
10160 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10161 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10162 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010163 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010164
10165 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10166 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10167 unobvious parameters.
10168
10169 Example :
10170 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10171 backend public_www
10172 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10173 stats enable
10174 stats hide-version
10175 stats scope .
10176 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010177 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010178 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10179 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10180
10181 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10182 backend private_monitoring
10183 stats enable
10184 stats uri /admin?stats
10185 stats refresh 5s
10186
10187 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10188
10189
10190stats scope { <name> | "." }
10191 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010193 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010194 Arguments :
10195 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10196 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10197 section in which the statement appears.
10198
10199 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10200 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10201 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10202 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10203 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10204 exists.
10205
10206 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10207 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10208 unobvious parameters.
10209
10210 Example :
10211 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10212 backend public_www
10213 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10214 stats enable
10215 stats hide-version
10216 stats scope .
10217 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010218 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010219 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10220 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10221
10222 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10223 backend private_monitoring
10224 stats enable
10225 stats uri /admin?stats
10226 stats refresh 5s
10227
10228 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10229
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010230
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010231stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010232 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010234 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010236 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010237 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10238
10239 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10240 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10241
10242 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10243 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010244 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010245
10246 Example :
10247 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10248 backend private_monitoring
10249 stats enable
10250 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10251 stats uri /admin?stats
10252 stats refresh 5s
10253
10254 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10255 global section.
10256
10257
10258stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010259 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10261 yes | yes | yes | yes
10262 Arguments : none
10263
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010264 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010265 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10266 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10267 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10268 - IP (socket, server)
10269 - cookie (backend, server)
10270
10271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010273 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010274
10275 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10276
10277
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010278stats show-modules
10279 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10281 yes | yes | yes | yes
10282 Arguments : none
10283
10284 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10285 values as a tooltip.
10286
10287 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10288 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10289 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10290
10291 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10292
10293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010294stats show-node [ <name> ]
10295 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010297 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010298 Arguments:
10299 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10300 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10301
10302 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10303 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010304 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010305
10306 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10307 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10308 unobvious parameters.
10309
10310 Example:
10311 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10312 backend private_monitoring
10313 stats enable
10314 stats show-node Europe-1
10315 stats uri /admin?stats
10316 stats refresh 5s
10317
10318 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10319 section.
10320
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010321
10322stats uri <prefix>
10323 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010325 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326 Arguments :
10327 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10328 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10329 query string.
10330
10331 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10332 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10333 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10334 possible to reach it in the application.
10335
10336 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010337 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010338 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10339 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10340 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10341 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10342
10343 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10344 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10345 an address or a port to statistics only.
10346
10347 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10348 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10349 unobvious parameters.
10350
10351 Example :
10352 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10353 backend public_www
10354 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10355 stats enable
10356 stats hide-version
10357 stats scope .
10358 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010359 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010360 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10361 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10362
10363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10364 backend private_monitoring
10365 stats enable
10366 stats uri /admin?stats
10367 stats refresh 5s
10368
10369 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10370
10371
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010372stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10373 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010375 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010376
10377 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010378 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010379 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010380 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010381 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10382
10383 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10384 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10385 the "stick-table" statement.
10386
10387 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10388 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10389 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10390 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10391 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10392
10393 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10394 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10395 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10396 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10397 transformation rules.
10398
10399 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10400 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10401 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10402 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10403 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10404 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10405 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10406
10407 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10408 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10409 ACL based conditions.
10410
10411 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10412 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10413 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10414 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10415
10416 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10417 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10418 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10419 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10420
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010421 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10422 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010423 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010424
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010425 Example :
10426 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10427 # last 30 minutes
10428 backend pop
10429 mode tcp
10430 balance roundrobin
10431 stick store-request src
10432 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10433 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10434 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10435
10436 backend smtp
10437 mode tcp
10438 balance roundrobin
10439 stick match src table pop
10440 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10441 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10442
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010443 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010444 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010445
10446
10447stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10448 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10450 no | no | yes | yes
10451
10452 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10453 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10454 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10455 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10456
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010457 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10458 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010459 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010460
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010461 Examples :
10462 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010463 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010464
10465 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10466 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10467 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10468
10469
10470 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10471 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10472 backend http
10473 mode http
10474 balance roundrobin
10475 stick on src table https
10476 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10477 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10478 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10479
10480 backend https
10481 mode tcp
10482 balance roundrobin
10483 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10484 stick on src
10485 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10486 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010488 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010489
10490
10491stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10492 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10494 no | no | yes | yes
10495
10496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010497 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010498 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010499 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010500 server is selected.
10501
10502 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10503 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10504 the "stick-table" statement.
10505
10506 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10507 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10508 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10509 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10510 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10511 address.
10512
10513 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10514 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10515 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10516 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10517 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10518 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10519 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10520 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10521 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10522 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10523
10524 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10525 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10526 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10527 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10528 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10529 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10530 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10531
10532 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10533 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10534 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10535 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10536
10537 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10538 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10539 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10540 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10541 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10542 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010543 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10544 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10545 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10546 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10547 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10548 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010549
10550 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10551 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10552 the request.
10553
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010554 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10555 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010556 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010557
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010558 Example :
10559 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10560 # last 30 minutes
10561 backend pop
10562 mode tcp
10563 balance roundrobin
10564 stick store-request src
10565 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10566 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10567 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10568
10569 backend smtp
10570 mode tcp
10571 balance roundrobin
10572 stick match src table pop
10573 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10574 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10575
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010576 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010577 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010578
10579
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010580stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010581 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10582 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010583 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010585 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010586
10587 Arguments :
10588 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10589 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10590 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10591 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10592
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010593 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10594 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10595 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10596 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10597
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010598 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10599 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10600 instance.
10601
10602 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10603 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10604 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10605 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10606 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10607 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010608 to 32 characters.
10609
10610 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10611 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10612 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010613 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010614 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10615 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010616
10617 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010618 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10619 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010620 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10621 increase.
10622
10623 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010624 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10625 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10626 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010627
10628 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10629 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10630 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10631 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010632 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010633 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10634 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10635 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10636 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10637 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10638 parameter (see below).
10639
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010640 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10641 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10642 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10643 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10644 soft restart.
10645
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010646 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10647 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010649 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10650 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10651 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10652 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010653 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010654 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010655 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10656 if not expiration delay is specified.
10657
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010658 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10659 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10660 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10661 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010662 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10663 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10664 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10665 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10666 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10667 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10668 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10669 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10670 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10671 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10672 types and their arguments.
10673
10674 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10675 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10676 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10677 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10678
10679 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10680 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10681 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010682 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010683
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010684 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10685 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10686 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010687 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010688 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010689 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010690
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010691 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10692 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10693 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10694 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10695
10696 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10697 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10698 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10699 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10700 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10701 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10702
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010703 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10704 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10705 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10706 they were received.
10707
10708 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10709 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10710 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10711 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10712 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10713
10714 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10715 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10716 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10717 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10718 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10719
10720 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10721 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10722 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10723
10724 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10725 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10726 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10727 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10728 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10729
10730 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10731 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10732 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10733 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10734 the client side.
10735
10736 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10737 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10738 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10739 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10740 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10741 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10742 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10743
10744 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10745 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10746 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10747 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10748 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10749 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010750 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010751
10752 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10753 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10754 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10755 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10756 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10757 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10758
10759 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010760 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010761 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10762 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10763
10764 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10765 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10766 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10767 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10768 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10769 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10770 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10771 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10772 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10773 recommended for better fairness.
10774
10775 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010776 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010777 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10778 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10779
10780 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10781 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10783 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10784 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10785 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10786 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10787 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10788 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10789 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010790
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010791 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10792 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010793 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10794 reference it.
10795
10796 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10797 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010798 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10799 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10800 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010801
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010802 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10803 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10804 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10805 something that can be ignored.
10806
10807 Example:
10808 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10809 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10810 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10811 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10812
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010813 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010814 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010815
10816
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010817stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010818 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10820 no | no | yes | yes
10821
10822 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010823 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010824 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010825 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010826 server is selected.
10827
10828 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10829 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10830 the "stick-table" statement.
10831
10832 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10833 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10834 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10835 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10836
10837 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10838 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10839 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10840 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10841 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10842 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010843 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010844 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10845 rules.
10846
10847 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10848 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10849 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10850 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10851 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10852 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10853 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10854
10855 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10856 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10857 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10858 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10859
10860 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10861 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10862 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10863 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10864 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10865 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010866 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10867 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10868 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10869 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10870 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10871 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10872 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10873 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10874 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010875
10876 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10877
10878 Example :
10879 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10880 backend https
10881 mode tcp
10882 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010883 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010884 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010885
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010886 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10887 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10888
10889 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10890 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10891 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10892
10893 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10894 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010895
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010896 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10897 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10898 # at offset 44.
10899
10900 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10901 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10902
10903 # Learn on response if server hello.
10904 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010905
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010906 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10907 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10908
10909 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10910 extraction.
10911
10912
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010913tcp-check comment <string>
10914 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10915 it fails.
10916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10917 yes | no | yes | yes
10918
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010919 Arguments :
10920 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10921 rule fails.
10922
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010923 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10924 user-friendly error reporting.
10925
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010926 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10927 "tcp-check expect".
10928
10929
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010930tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10931 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010932 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010933 Opens a new connection
10934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010935 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010936
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010937 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010938 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10939
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010940 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010941 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010942
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010943 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010944 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10945 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010946 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010947
10948 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010949
10950 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10951
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010952 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10953
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010954 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10955
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010956 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10957
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010958 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10959 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10960 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10961 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10962
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010963 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10964 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10965 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10966 haproxy -vv.
10967
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010968 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010969
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010970 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10971 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10972 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10973
10974 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10975 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10976 of the sequence.
10977
10978 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10979 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10980 do.
10981
10982 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10983 unset-var or comment rules.
10984
10985 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010986 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10987 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10988 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10989 option tcp-check
10990 tcp-check connect
10991 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10992 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10993 tcp-check send \r\n
10994 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10995 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10996 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10997 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10998 tcp-check send \r\n
10999 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11000 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11001
11002 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11003 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011004 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011005 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11006 tcp-check connect port 143
11007 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11008 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11009
11010 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11011
11012
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011013tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011014 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011015 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011016 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011017 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011019 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011020
11021 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011022 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11023
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011024 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11025 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11026 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11027 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11028 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11029 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11030 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11031 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11032 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11033 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11034
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011035 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011036 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11037 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011038 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11039 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11040 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11041
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011042 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11043 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11044 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011045 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11046 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11047 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11048 example 404 with disable-on-404
11049 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11050 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011051 By default "L7OK" is used.
11052
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011053 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11054 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011055 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11056 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11057 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11058 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11059 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11060 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011061
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011062 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011063 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011064 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11065 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11066 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11067 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011068 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11069
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011070 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11071 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11072 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11073 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11074
11075 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11076 informational message reported in logs if an error
11077 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11078 log-format string.
11079
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011080 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11081 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11082 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11083 followed by some converters.
11084
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011085 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11086 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11087 with the usual backslash ('\').
11088 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011089 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011090 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11091 used upper or lower case.
11092
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011093 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11094
11095 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11096 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11097 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11098 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11099 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11100 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11101 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11102 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11103
11104 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11105 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11106 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11107 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11108 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11109 expression.
11110
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011111 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11112 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11113 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11114 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11115 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11116 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11117
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011118 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11119 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11120 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11121 this exact hexadecimal string.
11122 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11123
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011124 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11125 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11126 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11127 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11128 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11129 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11130 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11131 size.
11132
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011133 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11134 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11135 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11136 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11137 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11138 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11139 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11140 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11141 in a binary string before matching the response's
11142 buffer.
11143
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011144 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011145 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011146 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11147 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11148 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11149 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11150 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11151 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11152 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11153 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11154 the null character.
11155
11156 Examples :
11157 # perform a POP check
11158 option tcp-check
11159 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11160
11161 # perform an IMAP check
11162 option tcp-check
11163 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11164
11165 # look for the redis master server
11166 option tcp-check
11167 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011168 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011169 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11170 tcp-check expect string role:master
11171 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11172 tcp-check expect string +OK
11173
11174
11175 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011176 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011177
11178
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011179tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11180tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11181 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11182 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011184 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011185
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011186 Arguments :
11187 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11188
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011189 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11190 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011191
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011192 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11193 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011194
11195 Examples :
11196 # look for the redis master server
11197 option tcp-check
11198 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11199 tcp-check expect string role:master
11200
11201 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011202 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011203
11204
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011205tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11206tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11207 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11208 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011210 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011211
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011212 Arguments :
11213 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011214
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011215 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11216 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011217
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011218 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11219 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11220 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011221
11222 Examples :
11223 # redis check in binary
11224 option tcp-check
11225 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11226 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11227
11228
11229 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011230 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011231
11232
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011233tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011234 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011236 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011237
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011238 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011239 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11240 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11243 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11245 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11246 and '-'.
11247
11248 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11249
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011250 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011251 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11252
11253
11254tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011255 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011257 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011258
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011259 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011260 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11261 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11264 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11266 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11267 and '-'.
11268
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011269 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011270 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11271
11272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011273tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11274 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11276 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011277 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011278 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11279 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011282
11283 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11284 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011285 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11286 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11287 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11288 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11289 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11290 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011292 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11293 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11294 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11295 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011296
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011297 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011298 - accept :
11299 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11300 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11301 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011303 - reject :
11304 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11305 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11306 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11307 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11308 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11309 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11310 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11311 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11312 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11313 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11314 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011315 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011316
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011317 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11318 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11319 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11320 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11321 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11322 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11323 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11324 hosts.
11325
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011326 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11327 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11328 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11329 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11330 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11331 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11332 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11333 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11334
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011335 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11336 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11337 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11338 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11339 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11340 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11341 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11342 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11343 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011344 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11345 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011346
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011347 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011348 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011349 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11350 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11351 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011352 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011353 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011354 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11355 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11356 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11357 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11358 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11359 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11360 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011362 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011363 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011365 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011366 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11367 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11368 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011370 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11371 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11372 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11373 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011375 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11376 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11377 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11378 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11379 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011380 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11381 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11382 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11383 layer7 information is extracted.
11384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011385 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11386 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11387 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11388 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11389 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011390
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011391 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11392 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11393 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11394 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11395
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011396 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11397 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11398 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11399 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11400
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011401 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11402 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11403 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11404 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11405 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011406
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011407 - set-src <expr> :
11408 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11409 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11410 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011411 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011413 Arguments:
11414 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11415 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011416
11417 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011418 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11419
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011420 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11421 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011422
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011423 - set-src-port <expr> :
11424 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11425 expression.
11426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011427 Arguments:
11428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11429 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011430
11431 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011432 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11433
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011434 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11435 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11436 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011437
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011438 - set-dst <expr> :
11439 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11440 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11441 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11442 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11443 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11444
11445 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11446 followed by some converters.
11447
11448 Example:
11449
11450 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11451 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11452
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011453 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11454 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11455
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011456 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11457 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11458 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11459 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11460
11461
11462 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11463 followed by some converters.
11464
11465 Example:
11466
11467 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11468
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011469 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11470 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11471 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11472
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011473 - "silent-drop" :
11474 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011475 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011476 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11477 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11478 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11479 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11480 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011481 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11482 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011483 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11484 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011485 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011486 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11487 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11488 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11489 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011491 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11492 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11493 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011495 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11496 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11497 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011499 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011500 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011501 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011503 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11504 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11505 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011507 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011508 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11509 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011510
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011511 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11512
11513 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11514
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11516
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011517 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011518
11519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011520tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11521 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011523 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011524 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011525 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11526 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011528 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011530 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011531 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11532 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11533 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11534 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011536 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11537 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11538 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11539 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011540 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11541 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11542 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11543 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11544 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11545 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011546 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011547 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011549 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11550 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11551 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11552 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011553
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011554 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011555 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011556 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011557 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11558 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011559 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011560 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011561 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011562 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011563 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011564 - set-dst <expr>
11565 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011566 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011567 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011568 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011569 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011570 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011572 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11573 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011574 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11575 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011576
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011577 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11578 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11579 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11580 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11581 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11582 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011584 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011585 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11586 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011587
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011588 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11589 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11590 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11591 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11592 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11593 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011595 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011596 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11597 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11598 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11599 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11600 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11601 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11602 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11603 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11604 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11605 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011606
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011607 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011608 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11609 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11610 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011611
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011612 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11613 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11614
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011615 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011616 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11617 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011618
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011619 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11620 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011621 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011622 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11623 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011624 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011625 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011626 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011627 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11628 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011630 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11631 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011632
11633 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11634 followed by some converters.
11635
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011636 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11637 <var-name>.
11638
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011639 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11640 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11641 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11642 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11643 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11644
11645 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11646 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11647 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11648 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11649 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11650 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11651 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11652 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11653 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11654 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11655 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11656
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011657 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11658 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11659 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11660 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11661 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11662
11663 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11664
11665 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11666
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011667 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11668 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11669 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11670 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11671 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11672 evaluated.
11673
11674 Example:
11675 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11676
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011677 Example:
11678
11679 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011680 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011681
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011682 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011683 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11684 # and reject everything else.
11685 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11686 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011687 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011688 tcp-request content reject
11689
11690 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011691 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11692 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11693 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011694 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011695
11696 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11697 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11698 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011699 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011700 tcp-request content reject
11701
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011702 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011703 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011704 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011705 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011706 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11707 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011708
11709 Example:
11710 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11711 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011712 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011714 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011715 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011716
11717 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011718 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011719 # protecting all our sites
11720 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011721 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11722 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011723 ...
11724 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11725
11726 backend http_dynamic
11727 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011728 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011730 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011731 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011732 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011733 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011735 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011736
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011737 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11738 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011739
11740
11741tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11742 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011744 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011745 Arguments :
11746 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11747 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11748 as explained at the top of this document.
11749
11750 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11751 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11752 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11753 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11754 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11755
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011756 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11757 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11758 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11759 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11760
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011761 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11762 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011763 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011764 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011765 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11766 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11767 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11768 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769
11770 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11771 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11772 it pass through unaffected.
11773
11774 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11775 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11776 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011777 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011778 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11779 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011780 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11781 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11782 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011783
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011784 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011785 "timeout client".
11786
11787
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011788tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11789 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11791 no | no | yes | yes
11792 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011793 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11794 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011795
11796 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011799 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11800 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011801 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11802 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011803
11804 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11805
11806 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11807 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11808 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11809 inserted.
11810
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011811 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011812 - accept :
11813 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11814 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11815 the rules evaluation.
11816
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011817 - close :
11818 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11819 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11820 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11821 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11822 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11823 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011824 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011825 protocols.
11826
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011827 - reject :
11828 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11829 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011830 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011831
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011832 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11833 Sets a variable.
11834
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011835 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11836 Unsets a variable.
11837
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011838 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11839 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11840 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11841 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11842
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011843 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11844 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11845 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11846 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11847
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011848 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11849 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11850 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11851 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11852 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011853
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011854 - "silent-drop" :
11855 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011856 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011857 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11858 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11859 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11860 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11861 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11863 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011864 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11865 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011866 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011867 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11868 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11869 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11870 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11871
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011872 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11873 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11874
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011875 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11876 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11877 for changing the default action to a reject.
11878
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011879 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11880 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11881 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11882 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011883 period.
11884
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011885 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11886 declared inline.
11887
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011888 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11889 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011890 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011891 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11892 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011893 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011894 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011895 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011896 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11897 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011898 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011899 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11900 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011901
11902 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11903 followed by some converters.
11904
11905 Example:
11906
11907 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11908
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011909 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11910 <var-name>.
11911
11912 Example:
11913
11914 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11915
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011916 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11917 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11918 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11919 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11920 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11921
11922 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11923
11924 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11925
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011926 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11927
11928 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11929
11930
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011931tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11932 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11934 no | yes | yes | no
11935 Arguments :
11936 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11937 below.
11938
11939 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11940
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011941 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011942 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11943 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11944 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11945 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11946 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11947 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11948 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011950 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11951 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11952 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11953 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11954 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11955 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11956 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11957 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11958 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11959 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11960 instead.
11961
11962 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11963 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11964 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11965 rules which may be inserted.
11966
11967 Several types of actions are supported :
11968 - accept : the request is accepted
11969 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11970 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11971 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011972 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011973 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011974 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011975 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011976 - silent-drop
11977
11978 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11979 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11980 sections for a complete description.
11981
11982 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11983 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11984 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11985
11986 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11987 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11988 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11989 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11990 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11991
11992 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11993 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11994
11995 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11996 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11997 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11998
11999 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12000 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12001 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12002
12003 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12004 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12005 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12006
12007 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12008 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12009 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12010
12011 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12012
12013 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12014
12015
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012016tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12017 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12019 no | no | yes | yes
12020 Arguments :
12021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12023 as explained at the top of this document.
12024
12025 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12026
12027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012028timeout check <timeout>
12029 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12030 established.
12031
12032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12033 yes | no | yes | yes
12034 Arguments:
12035 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12036 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12037 as explained at the top of this document.
12038
12039 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12040 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012041 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012042 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012043 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12044 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12045 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012046
12047 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12048 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12049
12050 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12051 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012052 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012053
12054 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12055 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12056 forget about it.
12057
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012058 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12059 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012060
12061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012062timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012063 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12065 yes | yes | yes | no
12066 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12069 as explained at the top of this document.
12070
12071 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12072 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12073 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012074 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12075 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12076 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12077 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012078 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12079 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12080 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012081 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012082 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012083 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12084 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012085 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12086 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012087
12088 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12089 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12090 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12091 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012092 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012093 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12094
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012095 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012096
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012097 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012099
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012100timeout client-fin <timeout>
12101 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12103 yes | yes | yes | no
12104 Arguments :
12105 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12106 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12107 as explained at the top of this document.
12108
12109 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12110 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12111 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12112 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12113 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12114 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12115 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012116 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12117 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12118 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012119
12120 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12121 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12122 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12123
12124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12125
12126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012127timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012128 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12130 yes | no | yes | yes
12131 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012132 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012133 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12134 as explained at the top of this document.
12135
12136 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012137 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012138 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012139 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012140 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12141 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012142
12143 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12144 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12145 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12146 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012147 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012148 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12149
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012150 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012152
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012153timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12154 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12156 yes | yes | yes | yes
12157 Arguments :
12158 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12159 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12160 as explained at the top of this document.
12161
12162 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12163 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12164 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12165 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12166 once the request has started to present itself.
12167
12168 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12169 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12170 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12171 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12172 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12173
12174 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12175 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12176 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12177 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12178
12179 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12180 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012182 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12183 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012184 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012185
12186 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12187 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12188 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12189 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012191 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12192 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012193 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12194
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012195 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12196
12197
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012198timeout http-request <timeout>
12199 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012201 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012203 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012204 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12205 as explained at the top of this document.
12206
12207 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12208 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12209 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12210 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12211 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12212 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12213 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012214 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12215 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12216 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12217 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012218 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012219 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12220 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012221
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012222 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12223 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12224 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12225 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12226 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012227 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012228
12229 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12230 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012231 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012232 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12233 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12234
12235 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012236 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12237 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12238 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012239
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012240 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012241 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012242
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012243
12244timeout queue <timeout>
12245 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12247 yes | no | yes | yes
12248 Arguments :
12249 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12251 as explained at the top of this document.
12252
12253 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12254 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12255 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12256 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12257 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12258
12259 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12260 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12261 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12262 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12263
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012264 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012265
12266
12267timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012268 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12270 yes | no | yes | yes
12271 Arguments :
12272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12274 as explained at the top of this document.
12275
12276 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12277 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12278 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12279 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12280 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12281 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12282 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12283
12284 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12285 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12286 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12287 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12288 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012289 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012290 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012291 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12292 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012293 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12294 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012295
12296 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12297 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12298 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12299 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012300 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012301 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12302
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012303 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012304
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012305
12306timeout server-fin <timeout>
12307 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12309 yes | no | yes | yes
12310 Arguments :
12311 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12312 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12313 as explained at the top of this document.
12314
12315 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12316 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12317 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12318 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12319 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12320 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12321 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12322 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12323 situations, it should not be needed.
12324
12325 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12326 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12327 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12328
12329 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12330
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012331
12332timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012333 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12335 yes | yes | yes | yes
12336 Arguments :
12337 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12339 as explained at the top of this document.
12340
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012341 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12342 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12343 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012344
12345 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12346 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12347 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12348 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012349 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012350
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012351 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012352
12353
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012354timeout tunnel <timeout>
12355 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12357 yes | no | yes | yes
12358 Arguments :
12359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12361 as explained at the top of this document.
12362
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012363 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012364 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12365 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12366 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012367 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12368 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012369 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12370 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12371 specified.
12372
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012373 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12374 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12375 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12376 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12377 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12378 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12379 state.
12380
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012381 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12382 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12383 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12384 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012385 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012386
12387 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12388 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12389 forget about it.
12390
12391 Example :
12392 defaults http
12393 option http-server-close
12394 timeout connect 5s
12395 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012396 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012397 timeout server 30s
12398 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12399
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012400 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012401
12402
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012403transparent (deprecated)
12404 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012406 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012407 Arguments : none
12408
12409 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12410 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12411 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12412 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12413 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12414 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12415 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12416 appropriate server.
12417
12418 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12419
12420 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12421 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12422
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012423 See also: "option transparent"
12424
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012425unique-id-format <string>
12426 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12428 yes | yes | yes | no
12429 Arguments :
12430 <string> is a log-format string.
12431
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012432 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12433 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12434 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12435 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012436
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012437 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12438 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12439 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12440 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12441 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12442 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12443 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12444 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012445
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012446 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12447 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012448
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012449 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012450
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012451 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012452
12453 will generate:
12454
12455 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12456
12457 See also: "unique-id-header"
12458
12459unique-id-header <name>
12460 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12462 yes | yes | yes | no
12463 Arguments :
12464 <name> is the name of the header.
12465
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012466 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12467 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012468
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012469 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012470
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012471 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012472 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12473
12474 will generate:
12475
12476 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12477
12478 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012479
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012480use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012481 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12483 no | yes | yes | no
12484 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012485 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12486 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012487
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012488 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12489 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012490
12491 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12492 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12493 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012494 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012495 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012496 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12497 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012498
12499 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12500 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12501 assign the backend.
12502
12503 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12504 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12505 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12506 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12507 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12508 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12509
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012510 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012511 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012512 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12513 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12514 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12515
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012516 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12517 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12518 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12519 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12520 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12521 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12522 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12523 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12524 cannot be forced from the request.
12525
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012526 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012527 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12528 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12529
12530 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12531 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012532
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012533use-fcgi-app <name>
12534 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12536 no | no | yes | yes
12537 Arguments :
12538 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12539
12540 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012541
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012542use-server <server> if <condition>
12543use-server <server> unless <condition>
12544 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12546 no | no | yes | yes
12547 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012548 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12549 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012550
12551 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12552
12553 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12554 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12555 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12556
12557 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12558 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12559 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12560 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12561 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12562 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12563 matches will assign the server.
12564
12565 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12566 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12567 with the next rules until one matches.
12568
12569 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12570 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12571 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12572 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12573
12574 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12575 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12576 stripped.
12577
12578 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12579 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012580 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12581 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12582 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012583
12584 Example :
12585 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12586 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12587 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12588 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012589 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012590 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012591 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012592 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12593 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12594
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012595 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12596 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12597 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12598 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012599 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012600 and we fall back to load balancing.
12601
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012602 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012603
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126055. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012606--------------------------
12607
12608The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12609depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12610settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12611written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12612described in this section.
12613
12614
126155.1. Bind options
12616-----------------
12617
12618The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12619as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12620no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12621parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12622while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12623provided immediately after the setting name.
12624
12625The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12626
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012627accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12628 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12629 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12630 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12631 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12632 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12633 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12634 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12635 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12636 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012637 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12638 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12639 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012641accept-proxy
12642 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012643 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12644 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012645 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12646 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12647 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12648 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012649 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012650 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12651 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012652 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12653 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012654
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012655allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012656 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012657 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012658 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012659 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12660 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012661
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012662alpn <protocols>
12663 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12664 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12665 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012666 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012667 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012668 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12669 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12670 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12671 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12672 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12673 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12674 preference, like below :
12675
12676 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012678backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012679 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012680 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12681
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012682curves <curves>
12683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12684 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12685 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12686 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12687 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12688 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12689
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012690ecdhe <named curve>
12691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012692 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12693 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012694
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012695ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12697 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12698 client's certificate.
12699
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012700ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12702 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12703 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12704 error is ignored.
12705
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012706ca-sign-file <cafile>
12707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12708 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12709 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12710 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12711 'generate-certificates' for details.
12712
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012713ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12715 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12716 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12717 'generate-certificates' for details.
12718
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012719ca-verify-file <cafile>
12720 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12721 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12722 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12723 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12724 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12725
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012726ciphers <ciphers>
12727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12728 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012729 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012730 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012731 information and recommendations see e.g.
12732 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12733 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12734 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12735
12736ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12738 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12739 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12740 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012741 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12742 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012743
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012744crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12746 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12747 to verify client's certificate.
12748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012749crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12751 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12752 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12753 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12754 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012755 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12756 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012757
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012758 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12759 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12760
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012761 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12762 are loaded.
12763
12764 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012765 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12766 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12767 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12768 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12769 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12770 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12771 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012772 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012773
12774 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12775 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12776 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12777 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012778 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12779 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012780
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012781 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012783 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012784 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12786 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012787 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12788 clients).
12789
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012790 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12791 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12792 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12793 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12794 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12795 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12796 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12797 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12798 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12799 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12800 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12801 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12802 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12803
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012804 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12805 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12806 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12807 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12808 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12809
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012810 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12811 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12812 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12813 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012814
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012815 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12816 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12817 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012818
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012819crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012821 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012822 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012823 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012824
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012825crt-list <file>
12826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012827 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12828 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012829
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012830 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12831
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012832 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12833 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12834 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12835 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12836 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012837
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012838 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012839 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12840 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12841 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12842 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12843 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012844 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12845 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12846 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012847
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012848 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12849 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12850 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012851
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012852 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12853
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012854 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12855 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12856 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12857 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12858 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12859 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12860 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12861 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012862
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012863 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012864 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012865 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012866 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012867 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012868 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012870defer-accept
12871 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12872 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12873 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012875 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12876 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12877 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12878 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12879 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12880 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12881 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12882
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012883expose-fd listeners
12884 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12885 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012886 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12887 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012888 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012889
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012890force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012891 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012892 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012893 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012894 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012895
12896force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012897 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012898 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012899 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012900
12901force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012902 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012903 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012904 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012905
12906force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012907 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012908 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012909 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012910
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012911force-tlsv13
12912 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12913 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012914 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012915
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012916generate-certificates
12917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12918 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12919 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12920 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12921 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12922 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12923 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12924 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12925 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12926 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12927 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12928
12929 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12930 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012931 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012932 certificate is used many times.
12933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012934gid <gid>
12935 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12936 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12937 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12938 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12939 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12940
12941group <group>
12942 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12943 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12944 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12945 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12946 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12947
12948id <id>
12949 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12950 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12951 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12952 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12953
12954interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012955 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12956 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12957 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12958 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12959 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12960 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012961 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12962 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12963 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12964 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12965 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12966 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012967
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012968level <level>
12969 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12970 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12971 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012972 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012973 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12974 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12975 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012976 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012977 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012978 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012979 all counters).
12980
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012981severity-output <format>
12982 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12983 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12984 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12985 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12986 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12987 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12988 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12989 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12990 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12991 rfc5424 convention.
12992
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012993maxconn <maxconn>
12994 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12995 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12996 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12997 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12998 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12999 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13000 eat all memory.
13001
13002mode <mode>
13003 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13004 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13005 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13006 UNIX sockets.
13007
13008mss <maxseg>
13009 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13010 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13011 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13012 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13013 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13014 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13015 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13016 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13017 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13018 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13019 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13020
13021name <name>
13022 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13023 page.
13024
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013025namespace <name>
13026 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13027 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13028 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13029 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013031nice <nice>
13032 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13033 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13034 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13035 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13036 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13037 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13038 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13039 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13040 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13041 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13042 one for an RDP socket.
13043
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013044no-ca-names
13045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13046 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013047 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013049no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013051 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013052 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013053 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013054 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13055 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013056
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013057no-tls-tickets
13058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13059 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13060 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013061 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13062 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013063 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13064 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13065 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013066
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013067no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013069 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013070 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013071 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013072 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13073 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013074
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013075no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013077 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013078 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013079 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013080 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13081 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013082
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013083no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013085 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013086 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013087 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013088 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13089 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013090
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013091no-tlsv13
13092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13093 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13094 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13095 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013096 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13097 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013098
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013099npn <protocols>
13100 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13101 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13102 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013103 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013104 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013105 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13106 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13107 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13108 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13109 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013110
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013111prefer-client-ciphers
13112 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13113 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13114 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013115 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13116 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13117 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013118
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013119process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013120 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013121 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013122 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013123 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13124 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13125 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13126 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013127 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013128 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13129 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13130 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13131 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13132 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013133
13134 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13135
13136 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13137 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13138 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13139 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13140 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13141 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13142 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13143 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013144
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013145proto <name>
13146 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13147 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13148 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13149 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013150 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013151 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013152 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013153 h2" on the bind line.
13154
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013155ssl
13156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013157 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013158 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13159 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013160 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13161 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013162
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013163ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13164 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013165 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13166 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13167 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013168 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13169
13170ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013171 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13172 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13173 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13174 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013175
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013176strict-sni
13177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13178 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13179 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13180 See the "crt" option for more information.
13181
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013182tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013183 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013184 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13185 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013186 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013187 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13188 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13189 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13190 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13191 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13192 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13193 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13194
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013195tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013196 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013197 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13198 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13199 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13200 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13201 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13202 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13203 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013204 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13205 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13206 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013207
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013208tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13209 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013210 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13211 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13212 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13213 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13214 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13215 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13216 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13217 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13218 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13219 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013220 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13221 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013223transparent
13224 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13225 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13226 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13227 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13228 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13229 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13230 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13231 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13232 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13233 so check for support with your vendor.
13234
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013235v4v6
13236 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13237 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13238 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13239 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013240 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013241
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013242v6only
13243 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13244 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13245 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013246 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13247 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013248
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013249uid <uid>
13250 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13251 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13252 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13253 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13254 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13255
13256user <user>
13257 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13258 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13259 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13260 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13261 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13262
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013263verify [none|optional|required]
13264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13265 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13266 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13267 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13268 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013269 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13270 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13271 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13272 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013275------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013277The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13278which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13279arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13280settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13281after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13282Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13283address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013285 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013286 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013287
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013288Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13289keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013291The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013292
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013293addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013294 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013295 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13296 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13297 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13298 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13299 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013300
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013301agent-check
13302 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013303 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013304 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13305 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13306 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013307
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013308 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013309 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013310 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13311 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13312 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013314 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13315 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13316 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13317 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13318 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013319
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013320 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013322
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013323 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13324 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13325 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013326
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013327 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13328 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13329 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013330
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013331 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013332 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13333 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13334 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13335 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013336 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013337 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013338
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013339 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13340 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013342 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13343 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13344 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13345 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13346 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13347 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13348 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13349 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13350 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013351
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013352 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13353 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013354 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13355 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13356 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013357 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013358
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013359 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013360 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013361
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013362agent-send <string>
13363 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13364 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13365 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13366 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13367 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13368
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013369agent-inter <delay>
13370 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13371 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13372
13373 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13374 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13375 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13376 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13377 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13378 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13379 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13380 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13381 of backends use the same servers.
13382
13383 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13384
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013385agent-addr <addr>
13386 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13387
13388 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13389 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13390 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13391 hostname, it will be resolved.
13392
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013393agent-port <port>
13394 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13395
13396 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13397
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013398allow-0rtt
13399 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013400 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13401 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013402
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013403alpn <protocols>
13404 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13405 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13406 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013407 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013408 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13409 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13410 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13411 now obsolete NPN extension.
13412 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13413 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13414
13415 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013417backup
13418 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13419 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13420 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13421 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013422 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13423 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013424
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013425ca-file <cafile>
13426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13427 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13428 server's certificate.
13429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013430check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013431 This option enables health checks on a server:
13432 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13433 considered available.
13434 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13435 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13436 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13437 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13438 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13439 set.
13440 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13441 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13442 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13443 exchanges succeed.
13444
13445 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13446 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13447 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13448 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13449 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013450 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013451 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13452
13453 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13454 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13455
13456 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13457 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13458
13459 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13460 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13461 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13462 available.
13463
13464 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13465 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13466 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13467
13468 Example:
13469 # simple tcp check
13470 backend foo
13471 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13472 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13473 backend foo
13474 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13475 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13476 backend foo
13477 option tcp-check
13478 tcp-check connect
13479 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013480
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013481check-send-proxy
13482 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13483 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13484 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13485 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13486 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13487 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13488 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13489
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013490check-alpn <protocols>
13491 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13492 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13493 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13494
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013495check-proto <name>
13496 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13497 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13498 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13499 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013500 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013501 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13502 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13503
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013504check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013505 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013506 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13507 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013508
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013509check-ssl
13510 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13511 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13512 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13513 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013514 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013515 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13516 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013517 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013518 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13519 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013520
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013521check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013522 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013523 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13524 for normal traffic.
13525
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013526ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13528 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13529 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013530 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13531 information and recommendations see e.g.
13532 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13533 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13534 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013535
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013536ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13538 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13539 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13540 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013541 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13542 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13543 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013545cookie <value>
13546 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13547 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13548 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13549 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13550 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13551 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13552 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13553
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013554crl-file <crlfile>
13555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13556 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13557 to verify server's certificate.
13558
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013559crt <cert>
13560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13561 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13562 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13563 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13564 certificate request.
13565
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013566disabled
13567 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13568 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13569 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13570 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13571 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013572 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013574enabled
13575 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13576 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13577 default value.
13578 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13579 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013581error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013582 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13583 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13584 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013586 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013588fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013589 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13590 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13591 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13592
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013593force-sslv3
13594 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13595 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013596 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013597 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013598
13599force-tlsv10
13600 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013601 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013602 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013603
13604force-tlsv11
13605 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013606 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013607 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013608
13609force-tlsv12
13610 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013611 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013613
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013614force-tlsv13
13615 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13616 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013617 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013619id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013620 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13621 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13622 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013623
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013624init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13625 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13626 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013627 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013628 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13629 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13630 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13631 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13632 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13633 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13634 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13635 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13636 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013638 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13639 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13640 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13641 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13642 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13643 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013644 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013645
13646 Example:
13647 defaults
13648 # never fail on address resolution
13649 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013651inter <delay>
13652fastinter <delay>
13653downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013654 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13655 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13656 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13657 between checks depending on the server state :
13658
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013659 Server state | Interval used
13660 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13661 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13662 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13663 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13664 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13665 or yet unchecked. |
13666 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13667 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13668 | "inter" otherwise.
13669 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013671 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13672 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13673 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13674 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013675 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13676 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13677 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13678 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13679 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013680
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013681log-proto <logproto>
13682 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13683 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13684 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13685 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013687maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013688 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13689 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013690 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13691 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013692 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13693 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13694 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13695 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13696
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013697 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13698 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13699 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13700 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13701 than 50 concurrent requests.
13702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013703maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013704 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13705 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13706 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13707 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013708 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13709 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13710 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13711 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13712 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13713 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13714 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013715
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013716max-reuse <count>
13717 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13718 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13719 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13720 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13721 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13722 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13723 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13724 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013726minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013727 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13728 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13729 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13730 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13731 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13732 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013733 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013734 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013735
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013736namespace <name>
13737 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13738 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13739 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13740 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13741
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013742no-agent-check
13743 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13744 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13745 default value.
13746 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13747 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13748
13749no-backup
13750 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13751 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13752 default value.
13753 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13754 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13755
13756no-check
13757 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13758 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13759 default value.
13760 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13761 "default-server" "check" setting.
13762
13763no-check-ssl
13764 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13765 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13766 default value.
13767 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13768 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13769
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013770no-send-proxy
13771 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13772 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13773 default value.
13774 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13775 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13776
13777no-send-proxy-v2
13778 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13779 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13780 default value.
13781 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13782 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13783
13784no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13785 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13786 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13787 default value.
13788 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13789 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13790
13791no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13792 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13793 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13794 default value.
13795 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13796 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13797
13798no-ssl
13799 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13800 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13801 default value.
13802 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13803 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13804
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013805 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13806 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13807 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13808
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013809no-ssl-reuse
13810 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13811 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13812 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13813 and for paranoid users.
13814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013815no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013816 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13817 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013818 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013819
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013820 Supported in default-server: No
13821
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013822no-tls-tickets
13823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13824 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13825 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013826 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13827 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013828 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13829 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13830 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013831 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013832
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013833no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013834 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013835 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13836 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013837 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13838 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013839 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013840
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013841 Supported in default-server: No
13842
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013843no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013844 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013845 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13846 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013847 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13848 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013849 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013850
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013851 Supported in default-server: No
13852
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013853no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013854 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013855 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13856 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013857 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13858 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013859 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013860
13861 Supported in default-server: No
13862
13863no-tlsv13
13864 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13865 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13866 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13867 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13868 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013869 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013870
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013871 Supported in default-server: No
13872
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013873no-verifyhost
13874 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13875 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13876 default value.
13877 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13878 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013879
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013880no-tfo
13881 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13882 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13883 default value.
13884 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13885 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13886
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013887non-stick
13888 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13889 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13890 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13891
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013892npn <protocols>
13893 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13894 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13895 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013896 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013897 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13898 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13899 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013901observe <mode>
13902 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13903 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13904 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13905 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13906 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13907 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013908 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013909
13910 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013912on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013913 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13914 Currently, four modes are available:
13915 - fastinter: force fastinter
13916 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13917 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13918 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13919 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13920
13921 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13922
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013923on-marked-down <action>
13924 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13925 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013926 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13927 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13928 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13929 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13930 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13931 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13932 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13933 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013934
13935 Actions are disabled by default
13936
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013937on-marked-up <action>
13938 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13939 Currently one action is available:
13940 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13941 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13942 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13943 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013944 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13945 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013946 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13947 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13948
13949 Actions are disabled by default
13950
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013951pool-low-conn <max>
13952 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13953 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13954 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13955 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13956 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13957 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13958 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13959 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13960 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13961 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13962 applying to "http-reuse".
13963
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013964pool-max-conn <max>
13965 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13966 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13967 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13968 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13969 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13970 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13971
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013972pool-purge-delay <delay>
13973 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013974 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013975 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013977port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013978 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13979 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13980 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13981 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13982 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13983 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13984
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013985proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013986 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13987 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13988 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13989 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013990 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013991 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013993redir <prefix>
13994 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13995 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13996 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13997 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13998 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13999 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14000 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14001 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014002 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014003 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014004 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14005 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14006 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14007 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14008
14009 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014011rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014012 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14013 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14014 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14015
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014016resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14017 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14018 server.
14019
14020 Available options:
14021
14022 * allow-dup-ip
14023 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14024 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14025 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14026 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14027 For such case, simply enable this option.
14028 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14029
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014030 * ignore-weight
14031 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14032 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14033 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14034
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014035 * prevent-dup-ip
14036 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14037 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14038 same fqdn.
14039 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14040
14041 Example:
14042 backend b_myapp
14043 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14044 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14045 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14046
14047 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14048 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14049 it
14050 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14051 different address
14052
14053 Default value: not set
14054
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014055resolve-prefer <family>
14056 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14057 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14058 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14059 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14060
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014061 Default value: ipv6
14062
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014063 Example:
14064
14065 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014066
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014067resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014068 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014069 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014070 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014071 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14072 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014073 configured network, another address is selected.
14074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014075 Example:
14076
14077 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014078
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014079resolvers <id>
14080 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14081 hostname.
14082
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014083 Example:
14084
14085 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014086
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014087 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014088
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014089send-proxy
14090 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14091 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14092 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14093 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014094 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14095 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14096 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14097 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14098 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14099 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14100 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14101 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14102 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14103 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014104 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14105 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014106
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014107send-proxy-v2
14108 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14109 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14110 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14111 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014112 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14113 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14114 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14115 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014116
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014117proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014118 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14119 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14120
14121 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14122 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14123 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14124 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14125 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14126 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14127 connection is supported).
14128 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14129 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14130 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14131 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14132 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14133 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14134 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014135
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014136send-proxy-v2-ssl
14137 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14138 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14139 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14140 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14141 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14142 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14143 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014144 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14145 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014146
14147send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14148 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14149 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14150 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14151 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14152 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14153 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14154 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14155 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014156 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14157 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014159slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014160 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14161 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14162 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14163 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14164 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14165 parameters :
14166
14167 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14168 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14169
14170 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14171 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14172 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14173 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14174
14175 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14176 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14177 seen as failed.
14178
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014179sni <expression>
14180 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14181 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14182 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14183 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014184 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14185 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014186 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014187 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14188 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014189
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014190source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014191source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014192source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014193 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14194 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14195 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14196 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14197
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014198 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14199 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14200 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14201 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14202 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14203 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14204 server.
14205
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014206 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14207 specifying the source address without port(s).
14208
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014209ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014210 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14211 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14212 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14213 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14214 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14215 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014216 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14217 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014218
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014219ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14220 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14221 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14222 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14223
14224ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14225 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14226 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14227 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14228
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014229ssl-reuse
14230 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14231 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14232 default value.
14233 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14234 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14235
14236stick
14237 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14238 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14239 default value.
14240 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14241 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014242
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014243socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014244 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014245 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14246 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14247
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014248tcp-ut <delay>
14249 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14250 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14251 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014252 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014253 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14254 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14255 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14256 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14257 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14258 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14259 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14260 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14261 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14262
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014263tfo
14264 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14265 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14266 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14267 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14268 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014269 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014271track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014272 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14273 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14274 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14275 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014276 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14277
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014278tls-tickets
14279 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14280 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14281 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014282 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14283 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14284 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014285 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014286 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014287
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014288verify [none|required]
14289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014290 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014291 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14292 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014293 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014294 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14295 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14296 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14297 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14298 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14299 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14300 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14301 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014302
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014303verifyhost <hostname>
14304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014305 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14306 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14307 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14308 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14309 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14310 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14311 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14312 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014314weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014315 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14316 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14317 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014318 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14319 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14320 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14321 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14322 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14323 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324
14325
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143265.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14327-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014328
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014329HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14330using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14331configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014332This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14333can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14334workload.
14335This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14336resolution at run time.
14337Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14338carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14339
14340
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143415.3.1. Global overview
14342----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014343
14344As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14345different steps of the process life:
14346
14347 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14348 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14349 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14350
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014351 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14352 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014353
14354A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14355 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14356 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14357 resolution to know this new IP.
14358
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014359When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014360HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014361SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14362from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14363will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14364will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014365
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014366A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014367 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014368 first valid response.
14369
14370 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14371 servers return an error.
14372
14373
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143745.3.2. The resolvers section
14375----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014376
14377This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014378HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14379contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014380
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014381When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14382uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14383is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14384answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14385
14386When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014387used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014388
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014389 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14390 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14391 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014392
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014393 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14394 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014395
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014396 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14397 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14398 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014399
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014400For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14401following scenarios are possible:
14402
14403 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14404 ignored
14405
14406 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14407 applied
14408
14409 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14410 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14411
14412 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14413 retries the query with a new type
14414
14415 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14416 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014417
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014418As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14419a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014420<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014421
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014422
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014423resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014424 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014425
14426A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14427
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014428accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014430 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014431 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14432 by RFC 6891)
14433
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014434 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14435
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014436nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14437 DNS server description:
14438 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14439 <ip> : IP address of the server
14440 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14441
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014442parse-resolv-conf
14443 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14444 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14445 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14446
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014447hold <status> <period>
14448 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14449 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014450 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014451 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014452 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14453 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14454 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14455
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014456 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014457
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014458resolve_retries <nb>
14459 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14460 giving up.
14461 Default value: 3
14462
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014463 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14464 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14465 type.
14466
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014467timeout <event> <time>
14468 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14469 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14470 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014471 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14472 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014473 Default value: 1s
14474 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014475 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014476 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014477 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14478 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14479
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014480 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014481
14482 resolvers mydns
14483 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14484 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014485 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014486 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014487 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014488 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014489 hold other 30s
14490 hold refused 30s
14491 hold nx 30s
14492 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014493 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014494 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014495
14496
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200144976. Cache
14498---------
14499
14500HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14501(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14502RAM.
14503
14504The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14505this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14506
14507If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14508independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14509when we try to allocate a new one.
14510
14511The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14512
14513It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14514"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14515for more details.
14516
14517When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14518replaced by "<CACHE>".
14519
14520
145216.1. Limitation
14522----------------
14523
14524The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14525
14526- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014527- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14528 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14529 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014530- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14531- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014532- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14533 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14534 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014535
14536- If the request is not a GET
14537- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14538- If the request contains an Authorization header
14539
14540
145416.2. Setup
14542-----------
14543
14544To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14545the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14546
14547
145486.2.1. Cache section
14549---------------------
14550
14551cache <name>
14552 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14553 size of cache is mandatory.
14554
14555total-max-size <megabytes>
14556 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14557 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14558
14559max-object-size <bytes>
14560 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14561 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14562 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14563
14564max-age <seconds>
14565 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14566 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14567 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14568 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14569 default.
14570
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014571process-vary <0 or 1>
14572 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14573 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14574 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14575 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14576 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14577
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014578
145796.2.2. Proxy section
14580---------------------
14581
14582http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14583 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14584 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14585 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14586 after this one.
14587
14588http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14589 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14590 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14591 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14592 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14593
14594
14595Example:
14596
14597 backend bck1
14598 mode http
14599
14600 http-request cache-use foobar
14601 http-response cache-store foobar
14602 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14603
14604 cache foobar
14605 total-max-size 4
14606 max-age 240
14607
14608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146097. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14610----------------------------------
14611
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014612HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14614The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14615these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14616but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14617data called patterns.
14618
14619
146207.1. ACL basics
14621---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014622
14623The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14624content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14625from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14626simple :
14627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014628 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014629 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14631 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14634adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014635
14636In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014639
14640This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14641Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14642and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014643an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14644conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14645as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14646are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014647
14648ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14649'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14650which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14651
14652There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14653performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014655The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14656specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14657this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014658methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14659ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660
14661Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14662 - boolean
14663 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14664 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14665 - string
14666 - data block
14667
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014668Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14669converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14670would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14671The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14672which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14673
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014674Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14675keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14676fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14677which are summarized in the table below :
14678
14679 +---------------------+-----------------+
14680 | Sample or converter | Default |
14681 | output type | matching method |
14682 +---------------------+-----------------+
14683 | boolean | bool |
14684 +---------------------+-----------------+
14685 | integer | int |
14686 +---------------------+-----------------+
14687 | ip | ip |
14688 +---------------------+-----------------+
14689 | string | str |
14690 +---------------------+-----------------+
14691 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14692 +---------------------+-----------------+
14693
14694Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14695matching method, see below.
14696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014697The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14698 - boolean
14699 - integer or integer range
14700 - IP address / network
14701 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14702 - regular expression
14703 - hex block
14704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014705The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14706
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014707 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14708 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014710 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014711 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014712 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014713 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014715The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14716read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14717if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14718lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14719will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14720beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14721a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14722lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14723exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14724
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014725The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14726parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14727ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14728a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14729check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14730
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014731The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14732socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14733file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14736loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14737
14738 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14739
14740In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14741the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14742case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14743as well.
14744
14745The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14746sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14747do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14748methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14749is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014750obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14752default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14753that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14754string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14755
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014756The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14757By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14758string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14759resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14760server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014761waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014762flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14763function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14766sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14767be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014768
14769 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14770 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14772 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14773 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14774 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014775
14776 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14777 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014779
14780 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014782
14783 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014785
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014786 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014787 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14788
14789 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14790 binary or string samples.
14791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14793 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14796 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14797 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14800 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14803 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14806 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14809 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014810 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14813 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14814 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014815
14816For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14817request, it is possible to do :
14818
14819 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14820
14821In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14822buffer, one would use the following acl :
14823
14824 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14825
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014826On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14827possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14828
14829 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14832criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14833method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14834to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14835criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14836the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014839the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14840For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14843 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14844 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14845 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014846
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014847
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014848The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14849types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14850combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14851brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14852default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 +-------------------------------------------------+
14855 | Input sample type |
14856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014857 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14859 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014861 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014863 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014865 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014867 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014869 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014871 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014873 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014875 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014877 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014879 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014881 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14883 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014885
14886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148877.1.1. Matching booleans
14888------------------------
14889
14890In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14891Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14892When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14893that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14894
14895Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14896return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14897"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14898
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149007.1.2. Matching integers
14901------------------------
14902
14903Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14904enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14905to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14906
14907Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14908matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14909lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014910
14911For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14912unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14913representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14914
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014915As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14916two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14917instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14918ranges and operators.
14919
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014920For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014921operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14922Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14923of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014925Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014926
14927 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14928 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14929 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14930 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14931 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014933For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014934
14935 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14936
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014937This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14938
14939 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14940
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149427.1.3. Matching strings
14943-----------------------
14944
14945String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14946different forms :
14947
14948 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014949 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950
14951 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014952 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953
14954 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14955 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14956
14957 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14958 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14959
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014960 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14962 matches.
14963
14964 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14965 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14966 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014967
14968String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14969exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14970characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14971string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14972to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014973before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014974
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014975Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14976(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14977Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14978
14979Example:
14980 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14981 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149847.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14985---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014986
14987Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14988they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14989possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14990passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14991the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014992the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14993match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014994
14995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149967.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14997-------------------------------------
14998
14999It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15000not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15001a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15002to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15003digits may be used upper or lower case.
15004
15005Example :
15006 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15007 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15008
15009
150107.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15011---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015012
15013IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15014netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15015within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015016host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015017difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15018at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15019does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15020parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015021
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015022The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15023abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15024
15025 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15026 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15027 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15028 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15029 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15030 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15031 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15032 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15033
15034Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15035192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15036
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015037IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15038Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15039trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15040IPv6 patterns.
15041
15042HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15043following situations :
15044 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15045 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15046 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15047 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15048 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15049 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15050 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15051 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15052 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15053 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055
150567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15057----------------------------------
15058
15059Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15060combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15061
15062 - AND (implicit)
15063 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15064 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15071indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15074"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15075requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15076is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15077
15078 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015079 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15080 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15081 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082
15083To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15084and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15085
15086 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15087 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15088 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15089 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015091 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15093 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15094 use_backend www if host_www
15095
15096It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15097expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15098be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15099the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15100
15101 The following rule :
15102
15103 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015104 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105
15106 Can also be written that way :
15107
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015108 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109
15110It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15111to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15112simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15113sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15114good use is the following :
15115
15116 With named ACLs :
15117
15118 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15119 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15120 monitor fail if site_dead
15121
15122 With anonymous ACLs :
15123
15124 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15125
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015126See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15127keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128
15129
151307.3. Fetching samples
15131---------------------
15132
15133Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15134against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15135sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15136ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15137of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15138available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15139
15140This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15141Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15142compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15143deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15144
15145The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15146matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15147method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15148indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15149
15150As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15151when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15152mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15153the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15154ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15155
15156Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15157multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15158when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015159incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15160are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015161is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15162all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15163
15164Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15165 - name
15166 - name(arg1)
15167 - name(arg1,arg2)
15168
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015169
151707.3.1. Converters
15171-----------------
15172
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015173Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15174of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15175is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15176was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015177has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015178unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15179
15180These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15181sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15182the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015184
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015185A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15186support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15187supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15188(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15189bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015192
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001519351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15194 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15195 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15196 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15197 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15198 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15199
15200 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015201 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15202 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015203 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15204 frontend http-in
15205 bind *:8081
15206 default_backend servers
15207 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15208 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15209
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015210add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015211 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015212 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015213 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15214 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015215 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015216 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15217 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15218 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15219 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015220 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015221 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015222
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015223aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15224 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15225 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15226 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15227 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15228 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15229 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15230
15231 Example:
15232 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15233 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15234
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015235and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015236 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015237 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015238 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15239 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015240 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015241 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15242 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15243 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15244 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015245 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015246 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015247
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015248b64dec
15249 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15250 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15251
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015252base64
15253 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015254 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015255 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015257bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015258 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015259 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015260 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015261 presence of a flag).
15262
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015263bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15264 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15265 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015266 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015267
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015268concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15269 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15270 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15271 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15272 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15273 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15274 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15275 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15276 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15277 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15278 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015279 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015280 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015281 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15282 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015283
15284 Example:
15285 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15286 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15287 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015288 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015289 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15290
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015291cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015292 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15293 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015294
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015295crc32([<avalanche>])
15296 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15297 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15298 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15299 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15300 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15301 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15302 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15303 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15304 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15305 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015306 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15307
15308crc32c([<avalanche>])
15309 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15310 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15311 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15312 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15313 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15314 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15315 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15316 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015317
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015318cut_crlf
15319 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15320 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15321 updated.
15322
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015323da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015324 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15325 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15326 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15327 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015328 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015329 configuration language.
15330
15331 Example:
15332 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015333 bind *:8881
15334 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015335 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015336
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015337debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15338 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15339 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15340 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15341 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15342 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15343 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15344 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15345 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15346 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15347 printable sample types.
15348
15349 Example:
15350 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015351
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015352digest(<algorithm>)
15353 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15354 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15355
15356 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15357 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15358
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015359div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015360 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15361 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015362 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015363 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15364 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015372
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015373djb2([<avalanche>])
15374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15377 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15378 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15379 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15380 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015381 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15382 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015383
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015384even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015385 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015386 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15387
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015388field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15389 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15390 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15391 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15392 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15393 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15394 fields.
15395
15396 Example :
15397 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15398 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015402
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015403fix_is_valid
15404 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15405 Information eXchange):
15406
15407 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15408 numeric
15409 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15410 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15411 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15412 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15413 checksum
15414
15415 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15416 the server can be parsed.
15417
15418 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15419 message, false if not.
15420
15421 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15422
15423 Example:
15424 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15425 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15426
15427fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15428 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15429 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15430 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15431 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15432 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15433 added.
15434
15435 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15436 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15437 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15438 fix_is_valid converter.
15439
15440 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15441
15442 Example:
15443 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15444 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15445 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15446 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15447 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015449hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015450 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015451 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015452 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015453 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015454
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015455hex2i
15456 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015457 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015458
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015459htonl
15460 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15461 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15462 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15463 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15464
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015465hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15466 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15467 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15468 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15469 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15470
15471 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15472 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15473
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015474http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015475 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15476 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015477 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15478 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15479 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15480 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15481 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15482 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15483 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15484 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015486iif(<true>,<false>)
15487 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15488 string otherwise.
15489
15490 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015491 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015492
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015493in_table(<table>)
15494 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15495 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15496 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015497 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015498 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15499
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015500ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15501 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015502 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015503 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15504 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15505 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15506 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15507 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015508
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015509json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015510 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015511 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015512 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015513 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15514 of errors:
15515 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15516 bytes, ...)
15517 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15518 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15519
15520 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15521 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15522 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15523 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15524 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15525 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015526 - "ascii" : never fails;
15527 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15528 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015529 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015530 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015531 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15532 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15533
15534 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015535 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015536
15537 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015538 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015539 capture request header user-agent len 150
15540 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015541
15542 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15543 GET / HTTP/1.0
15544 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15545
15546 Output log:
15547 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015549language(<value>[,<default>])
15550 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15551 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15552 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15553 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15554 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15555 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15556 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15557 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15558 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015559 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015560 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15561 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015563 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015565 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15566 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015567
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015568 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15569 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15570 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15571 use_backend spanish if es
15572 use_backend french if fr
15573 use_backend english if en
15574 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015575
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015576length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015577 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15578 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15579 type. The result is of type integer.
15580
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015581lower
15582 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15583 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15584 type. The result is of type string.
15585
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015586ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15587 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15588 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15589 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15590 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15591 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15592 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15593
15594 Example :
15595
15596 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015597 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015598 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15599
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015600ltrim(<chars>)
15601 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15602 representation of the input sample.
15603
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015604map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15605map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15606map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15607 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15608 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15609 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15610 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15611 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15612 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15613 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15614 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015616 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15617 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15618 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015619
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015620 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015621 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015623 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15625 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15626 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015627 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15628 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015629 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15631 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15633 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15635 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015637 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15639 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15641 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15642 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15643 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15644 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015645
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015646 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15647 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15648 the corresponding match text.
15649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015650 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15651 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15652 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15653 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15654 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015655
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015656 Example :
15657
15658 # this is a comment and is ignored
15659 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15660 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15661 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15662 | | | `---------- value
15663 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15664 | `---------------------------- key
15665 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15666
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015667mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015668 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15669 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015670 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015671 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015672 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015673 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15674 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15675 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15676 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015678 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015679
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015680mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15681 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15682 <packettype>.
15683 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15684 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15685 from.
15686 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15687 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15688 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15689
15690 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15691 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15692 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15693 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15694
15695 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15696 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15697 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15698 packets only):
15699 17: Session Expiry Interval
15700 33: Receive Maximum
15701 39: Maximum Packet Size
15702 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15703 25: Request Response Information
15704 23: Request Problem Information
15705 21: Authentication Method
15706 22: Authentication Data
15707 18: Will Delay Interval
15708 1: Payload Format Indicator
15709 2: Message Expiry Interval
15710 3: Content Type
15711 8: Response Topic
15712 9: Correlation Data
15713 Not supported yet:
15714 38: User Property
15715
15716 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15717 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15718 packets only):
15719 17: Session Expiry Interval
15720 33: Receive Maximum
15721 36: Maximum QoS
15722 37: Retain Available
15723 39: Maximum Packet Size
15724 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15725 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15726 31: Reason String
15727 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15728 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15729 42: Shared Subscription Available
15730 19: Server Keep Alive
15731 26: Response Information
15732 28: Server Reference
15733 21: Authentication Method
15734 22: Authentication Data
15735 Not supported yet:
15736 38: User Property
15737
15738 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15739 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15740 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15741 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15742
15743 Example:
15744
15745 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15746 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15747 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15748 if data_in_buffer
15749 # do the same as above
15750 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15751 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15752 if data_in_buffer
15753
15754mqtt_is_valid
15755 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15756
15757 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15758 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15759 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15760 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15761
15762 Example:
15763
15764 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15765 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15766
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015767mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015768 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015769 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15770 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015771 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015772 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015773 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015774 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15775 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15776 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15777 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015778 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015779 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015780
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015781nbsrv
15782 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15783 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15784 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15785 map lookup.
15786
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015787neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015788 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15789 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15790 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15791 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015792
15793not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015794 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015795 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015796 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015797 absence of a flag).
15798
15799odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015800 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015801 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15802
15803or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015804 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015805 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015806 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15807 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15811 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15812 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015813 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015814 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015815
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015816protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15817 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15818 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15819 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15820 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15821 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15822 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15823 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15824 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15825 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15826 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15827 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15828
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015829regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015830 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15831 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15832 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15833 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15834 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15835 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15836 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15837 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15838 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015839 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15840 of characters with other ones.
15841
15842 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15843 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15844 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15845 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15846 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15847 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015848
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015849 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015850
15851 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15852 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15853 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015854 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015855
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015856 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15857 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15858
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015859 # capture groups and backreferences
15860 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015861 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015862 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15863
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015864capture-req(<id>)
15865 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15866 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15867
15868 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015869 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15870 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015871
15872capture-res(<id>)
15873 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15874 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15875
15876 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015877 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15878 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015879
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015880rtrim(<chars>)
15881 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15882 of the input sample.
15883
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015884sdbm([<avalanche>])
15885 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15886 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15887 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15888 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15889 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15890 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15891 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015892 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15893 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015894
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015895secure_memcmp(<var>)
15896 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15897 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15898 match.
15899
15900 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15901 performed in constant time.
15902
15903 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15904 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15905
15906 Example :
15907
15908 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15909 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15910 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15911 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15912
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015913set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015914 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15915 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15916 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015917 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015918 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15919 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015920 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015921 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15922 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015923 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015924 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015925
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015926sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015927 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015928 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15929
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015930sha2([<bits>])
15931 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15932 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15933
15934 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15935 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15936
15937 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15938 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15939
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015940srv_queue
15941 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15942 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15943 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15944 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15945 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15946
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015947strcmp(<var>)
15948 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15949 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15950 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15951 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15952 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15953 shorter).
15954
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015955 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15956 strings in constant time.
15957
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015958 Example :
15959
15960 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15961 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15962 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15963
15964
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015965sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015966 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15967 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015968 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015969 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15970 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015971 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015972 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15973 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015974 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015975 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15976 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015977 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015978 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015979
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015980table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15983 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15984 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15985 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15986 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15987
15988
15989table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15993 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15994 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15995 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15996
15997table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016001 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16002 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16003
16004table_conn_cur(<table>)
16005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16008 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16009 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16010
16011table_conn_rate(<table>)
16012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16015 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16016 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16017
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016018table_gpt0(<table>)
16019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16022 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16023 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16024
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016025table_gpc0(<table>)
16026 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16027 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16028 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16029 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16030 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16031
16032table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16033 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16034 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16035 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16036 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16037 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16038 sample fetch keyword.
16039
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016040table_gpc1(<table>)
16041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16044 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16045 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16046
16047table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16051 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16052 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16053 sample fetch keyword.
16054
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016055table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016059 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16060 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16061
16062table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16065 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16066 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16067 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16068 keyword.
16069
16070table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016073 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016074 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16075 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16076
16077table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16080 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16081 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16082 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16083 keyword.
16084
16085table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016089 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16090 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16091 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16092 keyword.
16093
16094table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016097 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016098 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16099 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16100 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16101 keyword.
16102
16103table_server_id(<table>)
16104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16106 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16107 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16108 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16109 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16110
16111table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016115 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16116 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16117 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16118 keyword.
16119
16120table_sess_rate(<table>)
16121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16124 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16125 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16126 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16127 keyword.
16128
16129table_trackers(<table>)
16130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16133 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16134 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16135 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16136 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16137 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16138 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16139 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16140
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016141upper
16142 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16143 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16144 type. The result is of type string.
16145
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016146url_dec([<in_form>])
16147 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16148 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16149 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16150 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16151 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16152 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016153
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016154ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016155 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016156 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16157 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16158 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016159 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16160 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16161 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16162 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016163 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016164 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16165 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016166
16167 Example:
16168 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16169 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16170
16171 message Point {
16172 int32 latitude = 1;
16173 int32 longitude = 2;
16174 }
16175
16176 message PPoint {
16177 Point point = 59;
16178 }
16179
16180 message Rectangle {
16181 // One corner of the rectangle.
16182 PPoint lo = 48;
16183 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16184 PPoint hi = 49;
16185 }
16186
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016187 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16188 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16189 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016190
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016191 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16192 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016193 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016194 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16195
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016196 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016197
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016198 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016199
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016200 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16201 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16202 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016203
16204 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16205 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16206 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16207
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016208 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16209 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16210 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016211
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016212
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016213unset-var(<var name>)
16214 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16215 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16216 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16217 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16218 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16219 response),
16220 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16221 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16223 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16224
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016225utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16226 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16227 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16228 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16229 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16230 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16231 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16232
16233 Example :
16234
16235 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016236 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016237 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16238
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016239word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16240 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16241 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16242 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016243 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016244 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16245 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16246
16247 Example :
16248 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16249 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16250 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16251 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16252 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016253 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016254
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016255wt6([<avalanche>])
16256 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16257 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16258 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16259 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16260 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16261 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16262 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016263 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16264 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016265
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016266xor(<value>)
16267 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016268 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016269 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016270 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016271 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016272 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16273 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016274 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016275 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16276 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016278 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016279
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016280xxh32([<seed>])
16281 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16282 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16283 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16284 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16285 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16286 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16287 as cryptographically secure.
16288
16289xxh64([<seed>])
16290 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16291 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16292 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16293 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16294 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16295 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16296 as cryptographically secure.
16297
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300--------------------------------------------
16301
16302A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16303not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16304"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16305The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16306
16307always_false : boolean
16308 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16309 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16310
16311always_true : boolean
16312 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16313 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16314
16315avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016316 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16318 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16319 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16320 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16321 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16322 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16323 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16324 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16325 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16326 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16327 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16328 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16329 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016332 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16333 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16334 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16335 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016336 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16337
16338be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16339 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16340 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16341 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16342 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16343 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016344 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16345 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016346
16347 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16348 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16349 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16353 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16354 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016355 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16357 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016358
16359 Example :
16360 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16361 backend dynamic
16362 mode http
16363 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16364 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016366bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016367 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16368 of the string.
16369
16370bool(<bool>) : bool
16371 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16372 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016376 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16378 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016379
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016380 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016381 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016382 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016384 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16385 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016386
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016387 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016388 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016390 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016391 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016393 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016394
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016395 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16396 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016398 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016399
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016400cpu_calls : integer
16401 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16402 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16403 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16404 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16405 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16406 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16407
16408cpu_ns_avg : integer
16409 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16410 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16411 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16412 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16413 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16414 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16415 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16416 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16417 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16418 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16419 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16420
16421cpu_ns_tot : integer
16422 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16423 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16424 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16425 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16426 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16427 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16428 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16429 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16430 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16431 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16432 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16433 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16434 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16435
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016436date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016437 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016438
16439 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16440 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16441 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016442 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16443
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016444 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16445 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16446 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16447 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16448 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16449
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016450 Example :
16451
16452 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16453 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016454
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016455 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16456 # millisecond granularity
16457 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16458
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016459date_us : integer
16460 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16461 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16462 from the same timeval structure.
16463
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016464distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16465 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16466 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16467 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16468 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16469 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16470 list of supported tokens.
16471
16472distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16473 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16474 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16475 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16476 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16477 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16478 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16479 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16480 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16481 supported tokens.
16482
16483 Example :
16484 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16485 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16486 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16487 # send large files to the big farm
16488 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16489
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016490env(<name>) : string
16491 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16492 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16493 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16494 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16495 certain way.
16496
16497 Examples :
16498 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16499 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16500
16501 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16502 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16505 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16507 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016508 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16509 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016510 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016511 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16512 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016513
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016514fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16516 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16517 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016519fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16521 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16522 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16523 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16524 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16525 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16526 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16527 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016528
16529 Example :
16530 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16531 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16532 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16533 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16534 frontend mail
16535 bind :25
16536 mode tcp
16537 maxconn 100
16538 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16539 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16540 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16541 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016542
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016543hostname : string
16544 Returns the system hostname.
16545
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016546int(<integer>) : signed integer
16547 Returns a signed integer.
16548
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016549ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16550 Returns an ipv4.
16551
16552ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16553 Returns an ipv6.
16554
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016555lat_ns_avg : integer
16556 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16557 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16558 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16559 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16560 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16561 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16562 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16563 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16564 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016565 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16566 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16567 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16568 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16569 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16570 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016571
16572lat_ns_tot : integer
16573 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16574 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16575 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16576 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16577 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16578 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16579 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16580 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16581 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016582 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16583 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16584 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16585 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16586 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016587 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16588 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16589 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16590 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16591 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16592 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16593
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016594meth(<method>) : method
16595 Returns a method.
16596
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016597nbproc : integer
16598 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16599 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16600 and debugging purposes.
16601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16603 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16604 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16605 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016606 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16607 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16608 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016609
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016610prio_class : integer
16611 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16612 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16613 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16614
16615prio_offset : integer
16616 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16617 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16618 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16619 set-priority-offset".
16620
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016621proc : integer
16622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16623 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16624 debugging purposes.
16625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016627 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16628 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16629 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16631 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16632 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16633 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16634 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16635
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016636rand([<range>]) : integer
16637 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16638 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16639 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16640 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16641 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16642
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016643uuid([<version>]) : string
16644 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16645 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16646 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016648srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16649 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16650 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16651 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16652 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16653 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016654 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16655 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16656
16657srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16659 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16660 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16661 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16662 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16663 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16664 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16665
16666 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16667 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668
16669srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16670 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16671 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16672 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016673 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16675 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16676 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16677
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016678srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16680 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16681 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16682 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16683 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16684 fetch methods.
16685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16687 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16688 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016689 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016690 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16691 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016692 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016693 overloading servers).
16694
16695 Example :
16696 # Redirect to a separate back
16697 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16698 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16699 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16700
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016701srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16702 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16703 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16704 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16705
16706srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16707 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16708 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16709 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16710
16711srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16712 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16713 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16714 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16715
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016716stopping : boolean
16717 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16718 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16719 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16720
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016721str(<string>) : string
16722 Returns a string.
16723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16725 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16726 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16727
16728table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16729 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16730 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16731 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16732
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016733thread : integer
16734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16735 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16736 and debugging purposes.
16737
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016738var(<var-name>) : undefined
16739 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016740 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16741 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016745 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016749 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167517.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016752----------------------------------
16753
16754The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16755closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16756methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16757sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16758TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016759the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16760counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016761"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16762used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16763can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16764Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16765table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16766tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16767currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016769bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016770 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16771 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16772 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774be_id : integer
16775 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016776 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16777 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016779be_name : string
16780 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016781 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16782 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784dst : ip
16785 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16786 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16787 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16788 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016789 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16790 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16791 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16792 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16793 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16794 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795
16796dst_conn : integer
16797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16798 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16799 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16800 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16801 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16802 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16803 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16804 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016805
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016806dst_is_local : boolean
16807 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16808 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16809 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16810 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016811 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016812 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16813 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16814 it only once per connection.
16815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816dst_port : integer
16817 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16818 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16819 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16820 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16821 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16822 an HTTP header.
16823
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016824fc_http_major : integer
16825 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16826 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16827 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16828
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016829fc_pp_authority : string
16830 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16831 if any.
16832
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016833fc_pp_unique_id : string
16834 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16835 if any.
16836
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016837fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16838 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16839 header.
16840
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016841fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16842 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16843 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16844 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16845 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16846 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16847 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16848
16849fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16850 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16851 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16852 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16853 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16854 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16855 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16856
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016857fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016858 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16859 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16860 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16861 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16862
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016863fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016864 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16865 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16866 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16867 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16868
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016869fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016870 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16871 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16872 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16873 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16874
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016875fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016876 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16877 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16878 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16879 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16880
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016881fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016882 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16883 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16884 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16885 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16886
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016887fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016888 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16889 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16890 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16891 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16892
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016893fe_defbe : string
16894 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16895 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897fe_id : integer
16898 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016899 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16901
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016902fe_name : string
16903 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16904 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16905 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16906
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016907sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016908sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16909sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16910sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016911 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16912 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16913 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16914
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016915sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016916sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16917sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16918sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016919 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16920 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16921 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016923sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016924sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16925sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16926sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016927 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16928 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016929 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16930 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16931 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016932
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016933 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016934 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16935 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016936 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16937 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16938 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016939 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16940 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16941
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016942sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16943sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16944sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16945sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16946 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16947 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16948 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16949 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16950 when a first ACL was verified.
16951
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016952sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016953sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16954sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16955sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016956 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016957 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016959sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016960sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16961sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16962sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016963 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16964 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16965 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016967sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016968sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16969sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16970sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016971 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16972 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16973 See also src_conn_rate.
16974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016975sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016976sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16977sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16978sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016979 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016980 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016981
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016982sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16983sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16984sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16985sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16986 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16987 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16988
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016989sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16990sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16991sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16992sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16993 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16994 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016996sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016997sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16998sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16999sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017000 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17001 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17002 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017003 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17004 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17005 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017006
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017007sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17008sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17009sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17010sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17011 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17012 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17013 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17014 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17015 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17016 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17017
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017018sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017019sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17020sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17021sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017022 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017023 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17024 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17025
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017026sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017027sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17028sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17029sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017030 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17031 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17032 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17033 src_http_err_rate.
17034
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017035sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017036sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17037sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17038sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017039 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017040 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17041 src_http_req_cnt.
17042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017043sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017044sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17045sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17046sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017047 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17048 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17049 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17050 src_http_req_rate.
17051
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017052sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017053sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17054sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17055sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017056 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017057 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17058 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17059 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17060 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017061
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017062 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017063 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17064 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017065 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17066
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017067sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17068sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17069sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17070sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17071 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17072 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17073 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17074 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17075 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17076
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017077sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017078sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17079sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17080sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017081 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17082 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17083 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017085sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017086sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17087sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17088sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017089 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17090 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17091 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017093sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017094sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17095sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17096sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017097 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017098 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17099 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17100 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017101 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017102 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017104sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017105sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17106sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17107sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017108 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17109 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17110 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17111 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17112 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017113 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017114
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017115sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017116sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17117sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17118sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017119 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17120 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17121 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017123sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017124sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17125sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17126sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017127 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17128 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017129 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017130 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17131 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17133 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17134 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136so_id : integer
17137 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17138 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17139 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017140
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017141so_name : string
17142 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17143 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17144 strings instead of integers.
17145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017147 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17149 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17150 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017151 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17152 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17153 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017154 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17155 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17156 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17157 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17158 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17159 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17160 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017161
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017162 Example:
17163 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17164 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17167 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17168 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17169 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017170 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017172src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17173 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17174 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017175 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017176 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17179 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17180 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17181 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17182 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17183 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17184 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017185
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017186 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017187 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17188 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17189 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17190 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017191 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017192 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17193 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17194
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017195src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17196 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17197 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17198 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17199 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17200 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17201 was verified.
17202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017203src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017206 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017207 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017210 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17212 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017213 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017215src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17216 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17217 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17218 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017219 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017221src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017222 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017224 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017225 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017226
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017227src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17228 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17229 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17230 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17231 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17232
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017233src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17234 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17235 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17236 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17237 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017240 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017241 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017242 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17243 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017244 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17245 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17246 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017247
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017248src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17249 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17250 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17251 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17252 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17253 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17254 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17255 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017258 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017260 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017261 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017262 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17265 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17266 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17267 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17268 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017269 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017272 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17274 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017275 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17278 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17279 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17280 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017281 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017282 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17285 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17286 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17287 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017288 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17290 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017291
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017292 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017293 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017294 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017295 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017296
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017297src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17298 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17299 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17300 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17301 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17302 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17303 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17304
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017305src_is_local : boolean
17306 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17307 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17308 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17309 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017310 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017311 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17312 once per connection.
17313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017314src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017315 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17316 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17317 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17318 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17319 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017322 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17323 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17324 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17325 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17326 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017328src_port : integer
17329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17330 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17331 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17332 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017334src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017335 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017336 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17337 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17338 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017339 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17342 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17343 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17344 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17345 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017346 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17349 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17350 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17351 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17352 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17353 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17354 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17355 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17356 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017357
17358 Example :
17359 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17360 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17361 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17362 listen ssh
17363 bind :22
17364 mode tcp
17365 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017366 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017368 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017370srv_id : integer
17371 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17372 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017373 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017374
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017375srv_name : string
17376 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17377 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017378 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017379
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017383The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17384closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17385when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17386usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017387future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017388
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001738951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17390 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17391 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17392 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17393 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17394 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17395
17396 Example :
17397 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17398 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17399 # the request.
17400 frontend http-in
17401 bind *:8081
17402 default_backend servers
17403 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17404 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17405
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017406ssl_bc : boolean
17407 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17408 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017409 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17410 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017411
17412ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17413 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017414 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17415 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017416
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017417ssl_bc_alpn : string
17418 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17419 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017420 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017421 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17422 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17423 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17424 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17425 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017426 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17427 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017428
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017429ssl_bc_cipher : string
17430 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017431 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17432 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017433
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017434ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17435 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17436 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17437 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017438 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017439
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017440ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17441 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17442 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017443 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17444 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017445
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017446ssl_bc_npn : string
17447 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17448 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017449 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017450 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17451 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17452 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17453 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017454 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17455 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017456
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017457ssl_bc_protocol : string
17458 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017459 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17460 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017461
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017462ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017463 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017464 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017465 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17466 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017467
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017468ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17469 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17470 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17471 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017472 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017473
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017474ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17475 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17476 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017477 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17478 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017479
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017480ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17481 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17482 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17483 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017484 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017485
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017486ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17487 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017488 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17489 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17492 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17493 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17494 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17495 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17496 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017498ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17500 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17501 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17502 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017503
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017504ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017505 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17506 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17507 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17508 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17509 does not support resumed sessions.
17510
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017511ssl_c_der : binary
17512 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17513 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17514 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017516ssl_c_err : integer
17517 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17518 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17519 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17520 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17521 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017522
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017523ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17525 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17526 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17527 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17528 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17529 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17530 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17531 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017532 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17533 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17534 LDAP v3.
17535 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17536 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017538ssl_c_key_alg : string
17539 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17540 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17541 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017543ssl_c_notafter : string
17544 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17545 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17546 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548ssl_c_notbefore : string
17549 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17550 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17551 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017552
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017553ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17555 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17556 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17557 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17558 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17559 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17560 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17561 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017562 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17563 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17564 LDAP v3.
17565 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17566 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568ssl_c_serial : binary
17569 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17570 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17571 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17574 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17575 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17576 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017577 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17578 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17579
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017580 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017581 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17584 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17585 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17586 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588ssl_c_used : boolean
17589 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17590 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592ssl_c_verify : integer
17593 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17594 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17595 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17596 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598ssl_c_version : integer
17599 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17600 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017601
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017602ssl_f_der : binary
17603 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17604 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17605 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17606
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017607ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17609 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17610 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17611 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017612 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17614 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17615 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017616 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17617 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17618 LDAP v3.
17619 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17620 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622ssl_f_key_alg : string
17623 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17624 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17625 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627ssl_f_notafter : string
17628 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17629 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17630 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632ssl_f_notbefore : string
17633 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17634 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17635 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017636
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017637ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17639 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17640 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17641 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17642 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17643 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17644 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17645 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017646 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17647 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17648 LDAP v3.
17649 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17650 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017652ssl_f_serial : binary
17653 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17654 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17655 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017656
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017657ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17658 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17659 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17660 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17663 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17664 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17665 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667ssl_f_version : integer
17668 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17669 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17670
17671ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017672 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17673 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17674 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017676 Example :
17677 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17678 listen http-https
17679 bind :80
17680 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17681 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17682
17683ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17684 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17685 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17686
17687ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017688 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17690 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17691 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17692 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17693 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17694 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17695 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17696 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017698ssl_fc_cipher : string
17699 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17700 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017701
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017702ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17703 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17704 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017705 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017706
17707ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17708 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17709 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017710 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017711
17712ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17713 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17714 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17715 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017716 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017717 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017718
17719ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17720 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17721 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017722 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017723
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017724ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17725 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17726 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17727 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17728
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017729ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17730 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17731 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17732 transport layer.
17733 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17734 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17735 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17736 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17737
17738ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17739 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17740 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17741 transport layer.
17742 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17743 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17744 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17745 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17746
17747ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17748 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17749 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17750 transport layer.
17751 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17752 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17753 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17754 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17755
17756ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17757 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17758 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17759 transport layer.
17760 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17761 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17762 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17763 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17764
17765ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17766 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17767 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17768 transport layer.
17769 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17770 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17771 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17772 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017774ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017775 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17776 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017777 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17778 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17779 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17780 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017781
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017782ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17783 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17784 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17785 wait until the handshake happened.
17786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17788 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017789 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17790 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017791 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017792 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017793
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017794ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017795 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017796 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17797 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017799ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017800 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17802 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17803 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17804 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17805 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17806 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17807 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017809ssl_fc_protocol : string
17810 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17811 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017812
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017813ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017814 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017815 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17816 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017817
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017818ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17819 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17820 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17821 transport layer.
17822 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17823 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17824 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17825 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17826
17827ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17828 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17829 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17830 transport layer.
17831 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17832 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17833 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17834 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17835
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017836ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17837 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17838 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17839 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17842 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17843 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17844 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17845 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017846
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017847ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17848 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17849 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17850 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17851 BoringSSL.
17852
17853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854ssl_fc_sni : string
17855 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17856 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17857 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17858 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17859 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17860
17861 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17862 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17863 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017864 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017865 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17869 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017871ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17872 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17873 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017874
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017875ssl_s_der : binary
17876 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17877 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17878 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17879
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017880ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17881 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17882 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17883 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17884 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17885 does not support resumed sessions.
17886
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017887ssl_s_key_alg : string
17888 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17889 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17890 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17891
17892ssl_s_notafter : string
17893 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17894 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17895 transport layer.
17896
17897ssl_s_notbefore : string
17898 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17899 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17900 transport layer.
17901
17902ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17903 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17904 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17905 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17906 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17907 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17908 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017909 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17910 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017911 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17912 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17913 LDAP v3.
17914 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17915 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17916
17917ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17918 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17919 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17920 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17921 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17922 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17923 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017924 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17925 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017926 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17927 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17928 LDAP v3.
17929 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17930 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17931
17932ssl_s_serial : binary
17933 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17934 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17935 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17936
17937ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17938 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17939 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17940 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17941
17942ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17943 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17944 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17945 layer.
17946
17947ssl_s_version : integer
17948 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17949 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017950
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017954Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17955sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17956only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17957For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17958be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17959can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17960sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17961for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17962content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17967 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17970 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017973
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017974req.hdrs : string
17975 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17976 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17977 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17978 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17979
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017980req.hdrs_bin : binary
17981 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17982 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17983 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17984 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17985 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17986 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17987
17988 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17989
17990 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17991 str: <int:length><bytes>
17992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017993req.len : integer
17994req_len : integer (deprecated)
17995 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17996 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17997 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17998 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17999 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18000 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18001 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18002 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18005 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018006 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18007 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18008 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18009 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011 ACL alternatives :
18012 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18015 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18016 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18017 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18018 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020 ACL alternatives :
18021 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025req.proto_http : boolean
18026req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18027 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18028 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18029 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18030 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18031 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18032 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18033 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035 Example:
18036 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18037 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18038 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018039 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18042rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18043 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18044 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18045 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18046 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18047 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18048 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18049 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018051 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18052 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18053 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18054 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18055 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18056 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018058 ACL derivatives :
18059 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018061 Example :
18062 listen tse-farm
18063 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18064 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18065 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18066 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18067 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18068 persist rdp-cookie
18069 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18070 # This is only useful makes sense if
18071 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18072 stick-table type string size 204800
18073 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18074 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18075 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18078 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18081rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18082 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18083 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18084 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18085 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018087 ACL derivatives :
18088 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018089
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018090req.ssl_alpn : string
18091 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18092 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18093 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18094 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18095 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18096 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018097 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018098
18099 Examples :
18100 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18101 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18102 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018103 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018104 default_backend bk_default
18105
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018106req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18107 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18108 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018109 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18110 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18111 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18112 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18113 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18116req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18117 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18118 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18119 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18120 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18121 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18122 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18123 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125req.ssl_sni : string
18126req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18127 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18128 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18129 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18130 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18131 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018132 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18133 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18134 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18135 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18136 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18137 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18138 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18139 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18140 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142 ACL derivatives :
18143 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018145 Examples :
18146 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18147 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18148 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18149 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18150 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018151
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018152req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18153 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18154 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18155 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18156 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18157 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18158 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18159 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18160 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18161 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163req.ssl_ver : integer
18164req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18165 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18166 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18167 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18168 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18169 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18170 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18171 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018172 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175 ACL derivatives :
18176 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018177
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018178res.len : integer
18179 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18180 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18181 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18182 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18183 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18184 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18185 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018186 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018188res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18189 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018190 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018191 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018192 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018193 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18196 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18197 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18198 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018199 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18200 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018203
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018204res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18205rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18206 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18207 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18208 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18209 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18210 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18211 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18212 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214wait_end : boolean
18215 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18216 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018217 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18219 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018220 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18222 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224 Examples :
18225 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18226 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18227 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18230 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18231 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18232 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18233 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18234 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18235 tcp-request content reject
18236
18237
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182387.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239--------------------------------------
18240
18241It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18242This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18243data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18244its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18245HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18246content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18247to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18248more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18249response are indexed.
18250
18251base : string
18252 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18253 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18254 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18255 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18256 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18257 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18258 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18259 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18260
18261 ACL derivatives :
18262 base : exact string match
18263 base_beg : prefix match
18264 base_dir : subdir match
18265 base_dom : domain match
18266 base_end : suffix match
18267 base_len : length match
18268 base_reg : regex match
18269 base_sub : substring match
18270
18271base32 : integer
18272 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18273 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18274 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018275 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18276 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18277 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018278
18279base32+src : binary
18280 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18281 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18282 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18283 per-URL counters.
18284
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018285capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18286 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18287 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18288 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18289
18290capture.req.method : string
18291 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18292 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18293 because it's allocated.
18294
18295capture.req.uri : string
18296 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18297 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18298 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18299 allocated.
18300
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018301capture.req.ver : string
18302 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18303 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18304 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18305
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018306capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18307 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18308 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18309 The first entry is an index of 0.
18310 See also: "capture response header"
18311
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018312capture.res.ver : string
18313 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18314 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18315 persistent flag.
18316
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018317req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018318 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18319 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18320 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018321
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018322req.body_param([<name>) : string
18323 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18324 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18325 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18326 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18327 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18328 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18329 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18330 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18331 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18332 given.
18333
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018334req.body_len : integer
18335 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18336 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018337 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18338 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018339
18340req.body_size : integer
18341 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018342 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18343 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345req.cook([<name>]) : string
18346cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18347 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18348 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18349 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18350 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18351 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18352 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18353 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18354 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18355
18356 ACL derivatives :
18357 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18358 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18359 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18360 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18361 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18362 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18363 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18364 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18367cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18368 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18369 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18372cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18373 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18374 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18375 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18376 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18379 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18380 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18381 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18382 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018383 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18385 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18386 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18387 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18390 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18391 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18392 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18393 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018394 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18397 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18398 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18399 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18400 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18401 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18402 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18403 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18404 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018406req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18407 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18408 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18409 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18410 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18413 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18414 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18415 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18416 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18417 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18418 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18419 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18420 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018421 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018423 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425 ACL derivatives :
18426 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18427 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18428 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18429 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18430 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18431 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18432 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18433 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18434
18435req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18436hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18437 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18438 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18439 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18440 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18441 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18442 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18443 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18444 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18445 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18446
18447req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18448hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18449 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18450 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18451 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18452 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18453 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018454 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018455 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18456 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18457
18458req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18459hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18460 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18461 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18462 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18463 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18464 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18465 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18466 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18467
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018468
18469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018470http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18471 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18472 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18473 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18474 basic auth is supported.
18475
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018476http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18477 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18478 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18479 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18480 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18482 basic auth is supported.
18483
18484 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018485 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18486 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18487 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18488 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018489
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018490http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018491 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18492 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18493 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018494
18495http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018496 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18497 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18498 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018499
18500http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018501 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18502 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18503 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018505http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018506 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18507 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018508 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18509 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511method : integer + string
18512 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18513 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18514 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18515 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18516 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18517 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18518 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 ACL derivatives :
18521 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523 Example :
18524 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18525 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18526 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528path : string
18529 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18530 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18531 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18532 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18533 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018534 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537 ACL derivatives :
18538 path : exact string match
18539 path_beg : prefix match
18540 path_dir : subdir match
18541 path_dom : domain match
18542 path_end : suffix match
18543 path_len : length match
18544 path_reg : regex match
18545 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018546
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018547pathq : string
18548 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18549 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18550 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18551 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18552 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18553 result in both cases.
18554
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018555query : string
18556 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18557 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18558 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18559 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018560 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018561 which stops before the question mark.
18562
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018563req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18564 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18565 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18566 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18567 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018569req.ver : string
18570req_ver : string (deprecated)
18571 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18572 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18573 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575 ACL derivatives :
18576 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018577
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018578res.body : binary
18579 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18580 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18581 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18582 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18583
18584res.body_len : integer
18585 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18586 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18587 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18588 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18589
18590res.body_size : integer
18591 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18592 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18593 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18594 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18595 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18596 based expect rules.
18597
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018598res.cache_hit : boolean
18599 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18600 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18601
18602res.cache_name : string
18603 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18604 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18605 empty string.
18606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607res.comp : boolean
18608 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18609 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18610 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018612res.comp_algo : string
18613 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18614 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18615 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617res.cook([<name>]) : string
18618scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18619 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18620 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018621 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18622 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018624 ACL derivatives :
18625 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018627res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18628scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18629 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18630 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018631 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18632 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18635scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18636 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18637 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018638 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18639 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18642 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18643 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18644 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18645 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18646 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18647 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18648 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18649 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018650 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018652res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18653 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18654 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18655 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18656 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018657 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18658 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18661shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18662 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18663 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18664 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18665 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18666 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18667 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18668 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018669 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18670 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672 ACL derivatives :
18673 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18674 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18675 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18676 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18677 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18678 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18679 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18680 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18681
18682res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18683shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18684 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18685 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18686 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18687 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018688 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18691shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18692 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18693 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18694 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18695 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18696 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018697 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18698 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018699
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018700res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18701 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18702 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18703 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018704 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18705 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18708shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18709 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18710 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18711 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18712 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18713 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018714 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18715 based expect rules.
18716
18717res.hdrs : string
18718 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18719 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18720 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18721 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18722 based expect rules.
18723
18724res.hdrs_bin : binary
18725 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18726 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18727 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18728 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18729 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18730 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18731 (length of 0 for both).
18732
18733 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18734
18735 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18736 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738res.ver : string
18739resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18740 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018741 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18742 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744 ACL derivatives :
18745 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18748 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18749 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018750 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18754 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018756status : integer
18757 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18758 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018759 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18760 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018761
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018762unique-id : string
18763 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18764 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18765 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18766 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18767 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18768 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018770url : string
18771 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18772 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18773 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18774 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18775 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18776 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18777 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779 ACL derivatives :
18780 url : exact string match
18781 url_beg : prefix match
18782 url_dir : subdir match
18783 url_dom : domain match
18784 url_end : suffix match
18785 url_len : length match
18786 url_reg : regex match
18787 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789url_ip : ip
18790 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18791 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18792 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18793 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18794 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18795 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18796 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018798url_port : integer
18799 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18800 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18801 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18802 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018803
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018804urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18805url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18807 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018808 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18809 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18810 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18811 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018812 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18813 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018814 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18815 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817 ACL derivatives :
18818 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18819 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18820 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18821 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18822 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18823 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18824 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18825 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018826
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828 Example :
18829 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18830 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18831 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18832 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018833
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018834urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18836 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18837 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018838
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018839url32 : integer
18840 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18841 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18842 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18843 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18844 is an unsigned integer.
18845
18846url32+src : binary
18847 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18848 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18849 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18850
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018851
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200188527.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018853---------------------------------------
18854
18855This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18856used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18857purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18858There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18859or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18860any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18861for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18862
18863internal.htx.data : integer
18864 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18865 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18866
18867internal.htx.free : integer
18868 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18869 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18870
18871internal.htx.free_data : integer
18872 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18873 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18874
18875internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18876 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18877 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18878 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18879
18880internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18881 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18882 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18883
18884internal.htx.size : integer
18885 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18886 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18887
18888internal.htx.used : integer
18889 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18890 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18891 direction.
18892
18893internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18894 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18895 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18896 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18897 of the special value :
18898 * head : The oldest inserted block
18899 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018900 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018901
18902internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18903 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18904 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18905 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18906 integer or one of the special value :
18907 * head : The oldest inserted block
18908 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018909 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018910
18911internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18912 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18913 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18914 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18915 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18916
18917 * head : The oldest inserted block
18918 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018919 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018920
18921internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18922 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18923 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18924 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18925 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18926
18927 * head : The oldest inserted block
18928 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018929 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018930
18931internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18932 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18933 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18934 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18935 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18936
18937 * head : The oldest inserted block
18938 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018939 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018940
18941internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18942 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18943 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18944 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18945 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18946
18947 * head : The oldest inserted block
18948 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018949 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018950
18951internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18952 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18953 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18954 it returns false.
18955
18956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200189577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018958---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018960Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18961every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018962order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018964ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18965---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018966FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018967HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018968HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18969HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018970HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18971HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18972HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18973HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18974LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018975METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018976METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018977METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18978METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18979METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18980METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018981METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018982METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018983RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018984REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018985TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018986WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18987---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018988
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189908. Logging
18991----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018992
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018993One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18994provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18995very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18996provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18997state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018998to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018999headers.
19000
19001In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19002about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19003send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19004
19005 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19006 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19007 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19008 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19009 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019010 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019011 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019012
19013The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19014allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19015as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19016while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19017real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19018delay.
19019
19020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190218.1. Log levels
19022---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019023
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019024TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019025source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019026HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19027in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19028track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19029syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19030about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031
19032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190338.2. Log formats
19034----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019035
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019036HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019037and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19038slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19039options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019040
19041 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19042 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19043 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19044 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19045 extents.
19046
19047 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19048 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19049 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19050 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19051 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19052
19053 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19054 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19055 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19056 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19057 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19058
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019059 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19060 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19061 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19062 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19063
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019064 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19065
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019066Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19067specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19068field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19069servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19070always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19071identifier.
19072
19073Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19074 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19075 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19076 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19077 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19078
19079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190808.2.1. Default log format
19081-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019082
19083This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19084as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19085format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19086
19087 Example :
19088 listen www
19089 mode http
19090 log global
19091 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19092
19093 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19094 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19095 (www/HTTP)
19096
19097 Field Format Extract from the example above
19098 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19099 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19100 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19101 4 'to' to
19102 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19103 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19104
19105Detailed fields description :
19106 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19107 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19108 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19109 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19110 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19111 and processed the connection.
19112 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19113
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019114In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19115"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19116connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19117
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019118It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19119will eventually disappear.
19120
19121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191228.2.2. TCP log format
19123---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019124
19125The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19126is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19127information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19128counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19129emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19130environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19131the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19132sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019133specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19134not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19135fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19136marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019137
19138 Example :
19139 frontend fnt
19140 mode tcp
19141 option tcplog
19142 log global
19143 default_backend bck
19144
19145 backend bck
19146 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19147
19148 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19149 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19150 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19151
19152 Field Format Extract from the example above
19153 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19154 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19155 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19156 4 frontend_name fnt
19157 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19158 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19159 7 bytes_read* 212
19160 8 termination_state --
19161 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19162 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19163
19164Detailed fields description :
19165 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019166 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19167 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19168 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019169 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019170 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019171 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019172
19173 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019174 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19175 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19176 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019177
19178 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19179 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19180 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019181 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19182 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19183 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19184 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019185
19186 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19187 and processed the connection.
19188
19189 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19190 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19191 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19192 applications.
19193
19194 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19195 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19196 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19197 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19198 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19199
19200 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19201 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19202 See "Timers" below for more details.
19203
19204 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19205 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19206 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19207 "Timers" below for more details.
19208
19209 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019210 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019211 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19212 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19213 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19214 details.
19215
19216 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19217 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19218 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19219 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19220 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19221
19222 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19223 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19224 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19225 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19226 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19227 for more details.
19228
19229 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019230 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019231 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19232 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19233 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019234 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019235
19236 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19237 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19238 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19239 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19240 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19241 caused by a denial of service attack.
19242
19243 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19244 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19245 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19246 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19247 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19248 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19249 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19250 denial of service attack.
19251
19252 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19253 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19254 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19255 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19256 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19257 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19258 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19259 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19260 be processed than on other servers.
19261
19262 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19263 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19264 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19265 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19266 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19267 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19268 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19269 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19270 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19271 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19272 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19273 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19274 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19275
19276 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19277 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19278 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19279 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19280 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19281 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019282 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019283 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19284
19285 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19286 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19287 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19288 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19289 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19290 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019291 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019292 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19293 occurs.
19294
19295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192968.2.3. HTTP log format
19297----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019298
19299The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19300is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19301the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19302are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19303emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19304generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19305"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19306which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019307frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19308is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019309
19310Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19311slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19312with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19313
19314 Example :
19315 frontend http-in
19316 mode http
19317 option httplog
19318 log global
19319 default_backend bck
19320
19321 backend static
19322 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19323
19324 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19325 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19326 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019327 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019328
19329 Field Format Extract from the example above
19330 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19331 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019332 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019333 4 frontend_name http-in
19334 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019335 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019336 7 status_code 200
19337 8 bytes_read* 2750
19338 9 captured_request_cookie -
19339 10 captured_response_cookie -
19340 11 termination_state ----
19341 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19342 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19343 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19344 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19345 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019347Detailed fields description :
19348 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019349 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19350 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19351 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019352 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019353 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019354 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019355
19356 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019357 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19358 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19359 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019361 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19362 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019363
19364 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19365 and processed the connection.
19366
19367 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19368 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19369 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19370
19371 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19372 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19373 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19374 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19375 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19376 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19377
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019378 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19379 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19380 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019381 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019382 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19383 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019384 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19385 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019386
19387 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19388 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019389 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019390
19391 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19392 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019393 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19394 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019395
19396 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19397 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19398 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19399 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19400 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019401 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19402 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019404 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19405 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19406 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19407 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19408 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19409 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19410 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019411 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019412
19413 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19414 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19415 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19416
19417 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19418 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019419 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019420 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19421 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19422 overflowing.
19423
19424 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19425 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19426 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19427 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19428 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19429 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19430 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19431 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19432
19433 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19434 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19435 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19436 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19437 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19438 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19439 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19440 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19441
19442 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19443 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19444 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19445 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19446 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19447 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19448 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19449
19450 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019451 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019452 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19453 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19454 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019455 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019456 system.
19457
19458 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19459 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19460 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19461 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19462 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19463 caused by a denial of service attack.
19464
19465 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19466 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19467 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19468 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19469 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19470 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19471 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19472 denial of service attack.
19473
19474 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19475 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19476 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19477 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19478 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19479 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19480 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19481 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19482 processed than on other servers.
19483
19484 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19485 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19486 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19487 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19488 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19489 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19490 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19491 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19492 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19493 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19494 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19495 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19496 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19497
19498 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19499 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19500 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19501 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19502 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19503 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019504 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019505 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19506
19507 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19508 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19509 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19510 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19511 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19512 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019513 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019514 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19515 occurs.
19516
19517 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19518 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19519 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19520 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19521 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19522 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19523 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19524 cookies" below for more details.
19525
19526 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19527 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19528 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19529 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19530 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19531 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19532 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19533 and cookies" below for more details.
19534
19535 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19536 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19537 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19538 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19539 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19540 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19541 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19542 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19543
19544
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200195458.2.4. Custom log format
19546------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019547
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019548The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019549mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019551HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019552Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19553separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19554prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19555
19556Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19557variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019558("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019559
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019560If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019561as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019562less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19563the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19564
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019565Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19566"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19567delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19568preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019569
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019570Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19571'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19572https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19573such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19574
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019575Flags are :
19576 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019577 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019578 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19579 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019580
19581 Example:
19582
19583 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19584 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19585
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019586 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019588At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19589
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019590 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19591 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019592
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019593the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019594
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019595 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19596 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19597 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019598
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019599and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19600
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019601 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19602 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019603
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019604Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19605
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019606 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019607 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019608 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19609 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19610 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019611 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19612 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19613 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019614 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019615 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019616 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019617 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019618 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19619 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019620 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019621 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019622 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019623 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019624 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019625 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019626 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019627 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19628 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19629 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19630 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19631 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019632 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019633 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019634 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019635 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019636 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019637 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19638 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019639 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19640 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19641 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019642 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019643 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19644 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019645 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019646 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19647 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19648 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019649 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019650 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019651 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19652 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19653 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19654 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019655 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019656 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019657 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019658 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019659 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019660 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019661 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19662 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19663 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019664 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019665 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19666 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019667 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019668 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19669 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019670 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019671 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019672 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019673 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019674
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019675 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019676
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019677
196788.2.5. Error log format
19679-----------------------
19680
19681When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19682protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19683By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19684"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019685will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019686logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19687
19688The format looks like this :
19689
19690 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19691 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19692 Connection error during SSL handshake
19693
19694 Field Format Extract from the example above
19695 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19696 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19697 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19698 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19699 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19700
19701These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19702failures.
19703
19704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197058.3. Advanced logging options
19706-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019707
19708Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19709just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19710options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19711for more information about their usage.
19712
19713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197148.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19715------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019716
19717It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19718haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19719commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19720monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19721ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19722
19723 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19724 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19725 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19726 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19727
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019728 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19729 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019730
19731 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19732 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19733 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19734
19735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197368.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19737----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738
19739The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19740what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19741or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019742"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019743just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19744log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19745after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19746is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19747with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19748with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19749
19750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197518.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19752------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019753
19754Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19755for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19756"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19757retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19758raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19759a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19760file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19761you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19762"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19763
19764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197658.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19766--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019767
19768Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19769multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19770them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19771"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19772logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19773error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19774and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19775too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19776useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19777alternative.
19778
19779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197808.4. Timing events
19781------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019782
19783Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19784reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19785the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19786frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019787mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19788addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19789
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019790Timings events in HTTP mode:
19791
19792 first request 2nd request
19793 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19794 t tr t tr ...
19795 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19796 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19797 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19798 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019799 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019800 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19801
19802Timings events in TCP mode:
19803
19804 TCP session
19805 |<----------------->|
19806 t t
19807 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19808 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19809 |<------ Tt ------->|
19810
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019811 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019812 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019813 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19814 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19815 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019816 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019817 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19818 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19819 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19820 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019821
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019822 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19823 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19824 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019825 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19826 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19827 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19828 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19829 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19830 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019831
19832 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19833 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19834 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19835 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19836 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19837 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19838 request typed by hand during a test.
19839
19840 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19841 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019842 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019843 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19844 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19845 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19846 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019847
19848 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19849 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19850 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19851 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19852 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19853
19854 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19855 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19856 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19857 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19858 connection never established.
19859
19860 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19861 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19862 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19863 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19864 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19865 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19866 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19867 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19868 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19869 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19870 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19871
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019872 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19873 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19874 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19875 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19876 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19877 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19878
19879 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19880
19881 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19882 "Ta" can never be negative.
19883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019884 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19885 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019886 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19887 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019888 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019889
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019890 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019891
19892 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019893 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19894 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019895
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019896 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19897 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19898 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19899 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19900 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19901 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19902 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19903 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19904
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019905These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19906protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19907that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019908due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19909"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19910that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019911
19912Most common cases :
19913
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019914 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19915 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19916 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19917 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19918 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19919 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19920 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19921 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19922 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19923 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19924 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019925 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019926
19927 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19928 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19929 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19930 of ms on remote networks.
19931
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019932 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19933 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19934 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019935
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019936 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19937 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19938 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19939 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19940 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19941 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19942 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19943 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19944 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019945
19946Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019948 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019950 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019951
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019952 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19954 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019956 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019957 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19958 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19959 flags.
19960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019961 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19962 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019963 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19964 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19965 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19966 the client connection was maintained open.
19967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019968 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019969 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019970 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19972
19973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199748.5. Session state at disconnection
19975-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019976
19977TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19978"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
199792-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19980each of which has a special meaning :
19981
19982 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19983 session to terminate :
19984
19985 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19986
19987 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19988 server explicitly refused it.
19989
19990 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19991 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19992 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19993 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019994 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019995
19996 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19997 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019998
19999 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20000 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20001 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20002 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20003 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20004
20005 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20006 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20007 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20008 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20009 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20010
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020011 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20012 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20013
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020014 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20015 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20016 backup connections when going up.
20017
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020018 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020020 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20021 send or receive data.
20022
20023 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20024 send or receive data.
20025
20026 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20027 with nothing left in the buffers.
20028
20029 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20030
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020031 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020032 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20033
20034 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20035 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20036 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20037 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20038 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20039
20040 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20041 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20042
20043 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20044 server (HTTP only).
20045
20046 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20047
20048 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20049 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20050 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20051
20052 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20053 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20054 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20055
20056 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20057
20058 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20059 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20060
20061 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20062 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20063 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20064
20065 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20066 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020067 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20068 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020069
20070 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20071 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20072 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20073 another server.
20074
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020075 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020076 server.
20077
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020078 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20079 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20080 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20081 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20082
20083 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20084 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20085 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20086 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20087
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020088 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20089 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20090 "use-server" rule).
20091
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020092 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20093
20094 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20095 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20096
20097 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20098
20099 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20100 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20101 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20102
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020103 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20104 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020105 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020106 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20107 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020109 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20110
20111 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20112 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20113
20114 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20115
20116 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20117
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020118The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20119was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20121starvation, attacks, etc...
20122
20123The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20124alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20125easier finding and understanding.
20126
20127 Flags Reason
20128
20129 -- Normal termination.
20130
20131 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20132 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20133 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20134 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20135
20136 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20137 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20138 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20139 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20140 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20141 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020143 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20144 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020145 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020146
20147 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20148 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20149 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20150
20151 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20152 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20153 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20154 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20155 the server takes too long to respond.
20156
20157 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20158 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20159 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20160 long a time to respond.
20161
20162 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20163 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20164 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20165 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020166 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20167 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020168
20169 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20170 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20171 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20172 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20173 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020174 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020175 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20176 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20177 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20178 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20179 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20180 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20181 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20182 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020183 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020184 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20185 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20186 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020187
20188 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20189 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020190 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20191 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20192 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20193 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020194
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020195 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20196 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020198 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020199 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20200 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020201 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20203 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20204
20205 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20206 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20207 503 or 504 here.
20208
20209 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20210 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20211 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20212 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20213 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20214
20215 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20216 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020217 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020218 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20219 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20220
20221 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20222 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20223 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20224 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20225 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20226 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20227 between haproxy and the server.
20228
20229 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20230 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20231 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20232 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20233 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20234 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20235 solution is to fix the application.
20236
20237 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20238 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20239 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20240 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20241 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20242 external attacks.
20243
20244 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20245 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020246 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020247 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20248 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20249
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020250 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20251 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20252 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020253 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020254 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020255
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020256 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20257 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20258 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20259 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020260 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20261 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20262 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20263 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20264 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020265
20266 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20267 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20268 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20269 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20270
20271 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20272 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20273 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20274 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20275
20276 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20277 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20278 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20279 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020281The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20282persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20283important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20284re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20285
20286 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20287
20288 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20289 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20290 set on a GET request.
20291
20292 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20293 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020294 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020295 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20296
20297 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20298 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20299 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20300
20301 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20302 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20303 already got a cookie.
20304
20305 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20306 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20307 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20308 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20309 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20310
20311 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20312 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20313 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20314
20315 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20316 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20317 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20318
20319 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20320 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20321
20322 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20323 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20324 then advertised in the response.
20325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203278.6. Non-printable characters
20328-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020329
20330In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20331consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20332converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20333prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20334being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20335escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20336is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20337'}' when logging headers.
20338
20339Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20340issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20341containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20342
20343Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20344the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20345performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20346
20347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203488.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20349---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020350
20351Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20352achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020353section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020354cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20355the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20356the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020357locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20359user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20360a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20361wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20362
20363 Examples :
20364 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20365 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20366
20367 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20368 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20369
20370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203718.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20372---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020373
20374Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20375proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20376the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20377server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20378
20379Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20380response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020381section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382
20383It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020384time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20385appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20387and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20388follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20389request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20390in the logs.
20391
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020392As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20393frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20394an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020396 Example :
20397 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20398 listen proxy-out
20399 mode http
20400 option httplog
20401 option logasap
20402 log global
20403 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20404
20405 # log the name of the virtual server
20406 capture request header Host len 20
20407
20408 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20409 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20410
20411 # log the beginning of the referrer
20412 capture request header Referer len 20
20413
20414 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20415 capture response header Server len 20
20416
20417 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20418 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20419
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020420 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020421 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20422
20423 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20424 capture response header Via len 20
20425
20426 # log the URL location during a redirection
20427 capture response header Location len 20
20428
20429 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20430 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20431 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20432 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20433 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20434
20435 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20436 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20437 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20438 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020439 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020440
20441 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20442 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20443 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20444 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20445 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020446 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020447
20448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204498.9. Examples of logs
20450---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020451
20452These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20453them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20454reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20455
20456 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20457 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20458 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20459
20460 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20461 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20462
20463 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20464 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20465 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20466
20467 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20468 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20469
20470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20471 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20472 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20473
20474 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020475 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020476 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20477 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20478
20479 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20480 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20481 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20482
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020483 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20484 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20485 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20486 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20487 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20488 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020489
20490 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020491 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020492
20493 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20494 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20495 Nothing was sent to any server.
20496
20497 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20498 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20499
20500 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20501 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020502 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020503 send a 408 return code to the client.
20504
20505 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20506 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20507
20508 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20509 5 seconds ("c----").
20510
20511 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20512 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020513 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020514
20515 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020516 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020517 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20518 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20519 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20520 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20521 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020522
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020523
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205249. Supported filters
20525--------------------
20526
20527Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20528accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20529unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20530
20531See also : "filter"
20532
205339.1. Trace
20534----------
20535
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020536filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020537
20538 Arguments:
20539 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20540 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20541
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020542 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020543
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020544 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020545 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20546 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20547 amount of the parsed data.
20548
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020549 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020550
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020551This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20552callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20553information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20554filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20555
20556Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20557tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20558a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20559
20560
205619.2. HTTP compression
20562---------------------
20563
20564filter compression
20565
20566The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20567keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020568when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20569fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20570done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20571explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20572filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20573listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20574order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020575
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020576See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20577 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020578
20579
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200205809.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20581--------------------------------------------
20582
20583filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20584
20585 Arguments :
20586
20587 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20588 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20589 parsed.
20590
20591 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20592 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20593 part must be placed in its own scope.
20594
20595The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20596external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020597streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020598exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20599also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20600
20601SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20602the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20603
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020604For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020605"doc/SPOE.txt".
20606
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206079.4. Cache
20608----------
20609
20610filter cache <name>
20611
20612 Arguments :
20613
20614 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20615
20616The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20617"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020618cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020619other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20620case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20621is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20622filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020623listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20624order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020625
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020626See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20627 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20628
20629
206309.5. Fcgi-app
20631-------------
20632
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020633filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020634
20635 Arguments :
20636
20637 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20638
20639The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20640request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20641reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20642used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20643implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20644used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20645fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20646used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20647order.
20648
20649See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20650 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20651
20652
2065310. FastCGI applications
20654-------------------------
20655
20656HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20657feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20658the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20659FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20660servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20661FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20662backend.
20663
20664HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20665application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20666connection.
20667
2066810.1. Setup
20669-----------
20670
2067110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20672--------------------------
20673
20674fcgi-app <name>
20675 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20676 document root must be defined.
20677
20678acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20679 Declare or complete an access list.
20680
20681 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20682 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20683 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20684 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20685 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20686
20687docroot <path>
20688 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20689 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20690 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20691
20692index <script-name>
20693 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20694 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20695 is an optional setting.
20696
20697 Example :
20698 index index.php
20699
20700log-stderr global
20701log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20702 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20703 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20704
20705 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20706 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20707
20708pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20709 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20710 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20711 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20712
20713 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20714 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20715 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20716 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20717
20718 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20719 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20720
20721path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020722 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020723 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20724 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20725 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20726 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20727 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20728 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20729 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020730
20731 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020732 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020733 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20734 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20735 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20736 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020737
20738 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020739 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20740 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020741
20742option get-values
20743no option get-values
20744 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20745
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020746 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020747 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20748
20749 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20750 application will accept.
20751
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020752 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20753 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020754
20755 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020756 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020757 option is disabled.
20758
20759 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20760 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20761 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20762 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20763 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20764 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20765
20766option keep-conn
20767no option keep-conn
20768 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20769 sending a response.
20770
20771 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20772 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20773
20774option max-reqs <reqs>
20775 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20776 accept.
20777
20778 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20779 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20780 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20781 to 1.
20782
20783option mpxs-conns
20784no option mpxs-conns
20785 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20786
20787 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20788 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20789
20790set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20791 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20792 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20793 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20794 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20795
20796 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20797 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20798 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20799
20800 Example :
20801 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20802 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20803
20804 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20805
20806
2080710.1.2. Proxy section
20808---------------------
20809
20810use-fcgi-app <name>
20811 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20812
20813 Arguments :
20814 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20815
20816 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20817 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20818 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20819 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20820 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20821
20822 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20823 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20824 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20825 application are evaluated.
20826
20827
2082810.1.3. Example
20829---------------
20830
20831 frontend front-http
20832 mode http
20833 bind *:80
20834 bind *:
20835
20836 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20837 default_backend back-static
20838
20839 backend back-static
20840 mode http
20841 server www A.B.C.D:80
20842
20843 backend back-dynamic
20844 mode http
20845 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20846 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20847
20848 fcgi-app php-fpm
20849 log-stderr global
20850 option keep-conn
20851
20852 docroot /var/www/my-app
20853 index index.php
20854 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20855
20856
2085710.2. Default parameters
20858------------------------
20859
20860A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20861the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020862script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020863applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20864
20865 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20866 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20867 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20868 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20869 | | |
20870 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20871 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20872 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20873 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20874 | | application. |
20875 | | |
20876 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20877 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20878 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20879 | | |
20880 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20881 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20882 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20883 | | the application's configuration. |
20884 | | |
20885 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20886 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20887 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20888 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20889 | | |
20890 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20891 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20892 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20893 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20894 | | be defined. |
20895 | | |
20896 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20897 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20898 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20899 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20900 | | is not set too. |
20901 | | |
20902 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20903 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20904 | | set. |
20905 | | |
20906 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20907 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20908 | | the request. |
20909 | | |
20910 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20911 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20912 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20913 | | |
20914 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20915 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20916 | | script to process the request. |
20917 | | |
20918 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20919 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20920 | | |
20921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20922 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20923 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20924 | | |
20925 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20926 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20927 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20928 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20929 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20930 | | |
20931 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20932 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20933 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20934 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20935 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20936 | | side. |
20937 | | |
20938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20939 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20940 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20941 | | connected to. |
20942 | | |
20943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20944 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20945 | | |
20946 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20947 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20948 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20949 | | |
20950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20951
20952
2095310.3. Limitations
20954------------------
20955
20956The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20957way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20958during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20959establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20960application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20961or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20962message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20963these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20964and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20965
20966Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20967request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20968requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20969
20970About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20971into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20972fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20973"http-request" ones.
20974
20975Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20976FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20977processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20978must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20979here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020981/*
20982 * Local variables:
20983 * fill-column: 79
20984 * End:
20985 */